blob: 1114f63e4090dafd3c890863fd6564ca78602837 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100676. Cache
686.1. Limitation
696.2. Setup
706.2.1. Cache section
716.2.2. Proxy section
72
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200737. Using ACLs and fetching samples
747.1. ACL basics
757.1.1. Matching booleans
767.1.2. Matching integers
777.1.3. Matching strings
787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
807.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
827.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200837.3.1. Converters
847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
857.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
887.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100897.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200907.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091
928. Logging
938.1. Log levels
948.2. Log formats
958.2.1. Default log format
968.2.2. TCP log format
978.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100988.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100998.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001008.3. Advanced logging options
1018.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1028.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1038.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1058.4. Timing events
1068.5. Session state at disconnection
1078.6. Non-printable characters
1088.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1098.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1108.9. Examples of logs
111
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001129. Supported filters
1139.1. Trace
1149.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001159.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001169.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001179.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200118
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011910. FastCGI applications
12010.1. Setup
12110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12210.1.2. Proxy section
12310.1.3. Example
12410.2. Default parameters
12510.3. Limitations
126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127
1281. Quick reminder about HTTP
129----------------------------
130
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100131When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
133on almost anything found in the contents.
134
135However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
136formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
137correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
138
139
1401.1. The HTTP transaction model
141-------------------------------
142
143The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100144to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100145from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
146connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147will involve a new connection :
148
149 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
150
151In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
152establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
153by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
154length.
155
156Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
157to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
158however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
159response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
160header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
161
162 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
163
164Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
165power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
166but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200167a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100169Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
171second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
172page :
173
174 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
175
176This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
177latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
178correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
179the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100180server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
183time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
184are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
185parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
186carry the stream identifier.
187
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100188By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
189connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
190leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
192processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
193waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200194
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200195HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
197 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100198 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200200 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100202For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
203the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
205is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
206servers.
207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208
2091.2. HTTP request
210-----------------
211
212First, let's consider this HTTP request :
213
214 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
217 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
218 3 User-agent: my small browser
219 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
220 5 Accept: image/png
221
222
2231.2.1. The Request line
224-----------------------
225
226Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
227
228 - a METHOD : GET
229 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
231
232All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
233which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
234followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
235is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
236desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
237the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
238
239The URI itself can have several forms :
240
241 - A "relative URI" :
242
243 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
244
245 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
246 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
247
248 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
249
250 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
251
252 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
253 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
254 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
255 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
256 must accept this form too.
257
258 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
259 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
260 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
263 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
264 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
265 other protocols too.
266
267In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
268mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
269on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
270It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
271specific to the language, framework or application in use.
272
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100274assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
276received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
277processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
278as well as in server logs.
279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
296as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
298The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
299that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
300is one valid form of empty line.
301
302Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
303headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
304about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
305application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
306
307Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000308 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
310 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
311 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
312
313
3141.3. HTTP response
315------------------
316
317An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
318messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
319
320 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
323 2 Content-length: 350
324 3 Content-Type: text/html
325
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200326As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
327codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
328response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100329continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
330the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
331following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
332sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
333(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
334correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
335such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
336state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
337over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
338if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
339information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003421.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343------------------------
344
345Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
346
347 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
348 - a status code : 200
349 - a reason : OK
350
351The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100352 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
353 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
354 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
355 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
356 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000358Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100359"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
361messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
362or "Authentication Required".
363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100364HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200365
366 Code When / reason
367 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
368 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100371 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373 400 for an invalid or too large request
374 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
375 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200376 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100377 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100379 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
380 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
382 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
383 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200384 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
386 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
387 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
388
389The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3904.2).
391
392
3931.3.2. The response headers
394---------------------------
395
396Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
397the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
398details.
399
400
4012. Configuring HAProxy
402----------------------
403
4042.1. Configuration file format
405------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200406
407HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
408
409 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
410 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
411 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
412 "frontend" and "backend".
413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100414The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
415referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200416delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200418
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004192.2. Quoting and escaping
420-------------------------
421
422HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
423many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
424with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
425single quotes.
426
427If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
428them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
429escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
430
431Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
432
433 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
434 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
435 \\ to use a backslash
436 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
437 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
438
439Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
440the interpretation of:
441
442 space as a parameter separator
443 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
444 # hash as a comment start
445
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200446Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
447-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
448backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
449
450Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200451quoting.
452
453Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
454nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
455
456Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
457equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
458
459 Example:
460 # those are equivalents:
461 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
462 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
463 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
466
467 # those are equivalents:
468 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
469 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
472
473
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004742.3. Environment variables
475--------------------------
476
477HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
478interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
479configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
480optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
481shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
482underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
483
484 Example:
485
486 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
487
488 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
489
490 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
491
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200492Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
493file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200494
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200495* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
496 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
497
498* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
499 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
500 directory.
501
502* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
503
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500504* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200505 processes, separated by semicolons.
506
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500507* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200508 CLI, separated by semicolons.
509
510See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200511
5122.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200513----------------
514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100515Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100516values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
517otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
518numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
519for every keyword. Supported units are :
520
521 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
522 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
523 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
524 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
525 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
526 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
527
528
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005292.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200530-------------
531
532 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
533 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
534 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
535 global
536 daemon
537 maxconn 256
538
539 defaults
540 mode http
541 timeout connect 5000ms
542 timeout client 50000ms
543 timeout server 50000ms
544
545 frontend http-in
546 bind *:80
547 default_backend servers
548
549 backend servers
550 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
551
552
553 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
554 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
555 global
556 daemon
557 maxconn 256
558
559 defaults
560 mode http
561 timeout connect 5000ms
562 timeout client 50000ms
563 timeout server 50000ms
564
565 listen http-in
566 bind *:80
567 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
568
569
570Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
571
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100572 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200573
574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005753. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576--------------------
577
578Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
579are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
580of them have command-line equivalents.
581
582The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
583
584 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200585 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - description
591 - deviceatlas-json-file
592 - deviceatlas-log-level
593 - deviceatlas-separator
594 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900595 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 - gid
597 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100598 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200599 - h1-case-adjust
600 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100601 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100602 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100605 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200607 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200609 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-options
623 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-options
626 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100627 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100628 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100629 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100630 - 51degrees-data-file
631 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200632 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200633 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200634 - wurfl-data-file
635 - wurfl-information-list
636 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200637 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100638 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100641 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200642 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200644 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100645 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100646 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100647 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200648 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200649 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200650 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200651 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652 - noepoll
653 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000654 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100656 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300657 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000658 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100659 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200660 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200661 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200662 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000663 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000664 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200665 - tune.buffers.limit
666 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200667 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200668 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100669 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200670 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200671 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200672 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100673 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200674 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200675 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100676 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100677 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100678 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100679 - tune.lua.session-timeout
680 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200681 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100682 - tune.maxaccept
683 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200684 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200685 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200686 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100687 - tune.rcvbuf.client
688 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100689 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200690 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100691 - tune.sndbuf.client
692 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100693 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100694 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200695 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100696 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200697 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200698 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100699 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200700 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100701 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200702 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
703 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
704 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100705 - tune.zlib.memlevel
706 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100707
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708 * Debugging
709 - debug
710 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711
712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007133.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714------------------------------------
715
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200716ca-base <dir>
717 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200718 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
719 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721chroot <jail dir>
722 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
723 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
724 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
725 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
726 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100727 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100728
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
730 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
731 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
732 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
733 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
734 set. These sets have the format
735
736 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
737
738 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
741 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100742 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
743 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100744 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100745 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100746 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
749 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
750 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
751 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100752
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100753 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
754 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
755 on the machine's word size.
756
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100757 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
759 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
760 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
761 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
762 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
763 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100764
765 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
767
768 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
769 # first 4 CPUs
770
771 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
772 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
773 # word size.
774
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100775 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
778 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
779 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
780
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100781 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
782 # and so on.
783 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
784 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
786
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100787 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100788 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
789 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
790 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
791
792 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
793 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
794 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
795
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100796 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
797 # and a thread range.
798 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
799 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
800 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
801
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200802crt-base <dir>
803 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100804 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
805 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200806
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807daemon
808 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
809 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100810 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
811 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200812
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200813deviceatlas-json-file <path>
814 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100815 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200816
817deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100818 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200819 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
820
821deviceatlas-separator <char>
822 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
823 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
824
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100825deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200826 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
827 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
828 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100829
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900830external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100831 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
832 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
834 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
835 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
836 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
837 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839gid <number>
840 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
841 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
842 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100843 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
844 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100846
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100847group <group name>
848 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
849 See also "gid" and "user".
850
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100851hard-stop-after <time>
852 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
853
854 Arguments :
855 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
856 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
857 SIGUSR1 signal.
858
859 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
860 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
861 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
862
863 Example:
864 global
865 hard-stop-after 30s
866
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200867h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
868 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
869 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
870 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
871 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
872 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
873 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
874 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
875 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
876 specified in a proxy.
877
878 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
879 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
880 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
881 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
882 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
883 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
884 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
885
886 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
887 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
888 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
889 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
890 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
891
892 Example:
893 global
894 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
895
896 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
897 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
898
899h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
900 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
901 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
902 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
903 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
904 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
905 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
906 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
907 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
908
909 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
910 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
911 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
912
913 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
914 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
915
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100916insecure-fork-wanted
917 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
918 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
919 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
920 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
921 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
922 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
923 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
924 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
925 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
926 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
927 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
928 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
929 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
930 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
931 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
932 disable it.
933
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100934insecure-setuid-wanted
935 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
936 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
937 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
938 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
939 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
940 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
941 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
942 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
943 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
944 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
945 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
946 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
947 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
948 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
949
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200950log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
951 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100952 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100953 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100954 configured with "log global".
955
956 <address> can be one of:
957
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100958 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100959 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
960 port).
961
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100962 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
963 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
964 port).
965
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100966 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100967 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
968 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100969 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100970
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100971 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
972 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
973 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
974 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
975 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
976 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
977 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
978 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
979 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
980 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
981 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
982 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
983 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
984 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100985 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
986 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987
988 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
989 "fd@2", see above.
990
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200991 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
992 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
993 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
994 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
995 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
996
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200997 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
998 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100999
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001000 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1001 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1002 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1003 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1004 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1005 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1006 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1007 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1008 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1009 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001010 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1011 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001012
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001013 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1014 one of the following :
1015
1016 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1017 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1018
1019 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1020 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1021
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001022 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1023 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1024 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1025 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1026 logger consumes.
1027
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001028 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1029 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1030 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1031 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1032
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001033 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1034 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1035 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1036 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1037 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1038
1039 <sample_size>
1040 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1041 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1042 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1043 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1044 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1045
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001046 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001047
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001048 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1049 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1050 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1051
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001052 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1053 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1054 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1055 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
1057 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001058 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1059 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1060 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1061 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1062 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1063 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001065 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001067log-send-hostname [<string>]
1068 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1069 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1070 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1071 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1072 the logs.
1073
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001074log-tag <string>
1075 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1076 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1077 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001078 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001079
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001080lua-load <file>
1081 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1082 used multiple times.
1083
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001084master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001085 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1086 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1087 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001088 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001089 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1090 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001091 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1092 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1093 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1094 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1095 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001096
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001097 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001098
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001099mworker-max-reloads <number>
1100 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001101 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001102 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1103 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1104 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1105
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001106nbproc <number>
1107 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1108 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1109 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001110 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1111 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001112 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1113 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001115nbthread <number>
1116 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001117 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1118 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1119 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1120 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1121 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001122 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1123 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1124 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1125 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1126 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1127 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1128 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001129
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001130pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001131 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001132 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1133 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1134
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001135presetenv <name> <value>
1136 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1137 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1138 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1139 and "unsetenv".
1140
1141resetenv [<name> ...]
1142 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1143 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1144 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1145 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1146 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1147 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1148 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1149 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1150
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001151stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001152 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1153 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1154 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1155 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1156 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1157 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001158 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001159 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1160 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1161 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1162 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001163
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001164server-state-base <directory>
1165 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001166 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1167 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001168
1169server-state-file <file>
1170 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1171 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1172 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1173 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1174 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1175 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1176 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1177 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001178 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1179 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181setenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1184 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001187set-dumpable
1188 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001189 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1190 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1191 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1192 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1193 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1194 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1195 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1196 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1197 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1198 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1199 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1200 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1201 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1202 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1203 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1204 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1205 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001206
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001207ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001210 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001211 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001212 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1213 information and recommendations see e.g.
1214 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1215 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1216 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1217 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001218
1219ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1221 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1222 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1223 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1224 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001225 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1226 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1227 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001228 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001229
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001230ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1232 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1233 keyword to see available options.
1234
1235 Example:
1236 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001237 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001238
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001239ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1240 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1241 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001242 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001243 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001244 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1245 information and recommendations see e.g.
1246 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1247 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1248 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1249 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1250 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001251
1252ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1254 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1255 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1256 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1257 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1259 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1260 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1261 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001262
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001263ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1265 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1266 keyword to see available options.
1267
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001268ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1270 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1271 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001272 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001273 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001274 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1275 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1276 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1277 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001278 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1279 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1280 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1281
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001282ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1283 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1284 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1285 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1286
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001287stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1288 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1289 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1290 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001291 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001292 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001293
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001294 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1295 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1296 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001297
1298stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1299 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1300 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001301 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001302
1303stats maxconn <connections>
1304 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1305 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1306
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001307uid <number>
1308 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1309 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1310 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1311 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1312
1313ulimit-n <number>
1314 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1315 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1316 option.
1317
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001318unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1319 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1320
1321 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1322 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1323 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1324 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1325 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1326 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1327 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1328 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1329 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1330 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1331
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001332unsetenv [<name> ...]
1333 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1334 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1335 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1336 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1337 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1338 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1339 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1340
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341user <user name>
1342 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1343 See also "uid" and "group".
1344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001345node <name>
1346 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1347
1348 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1349 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1350 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1351 traffic.
1352
1353description <text>
1354 Add a text that describes the instance.
1355
1356 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1357 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1358 "<" and ">" characters.
1359
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100136051degrees-data-file <file path>
1361 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001362 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001363
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001364 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001365 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1366
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001368 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1369 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1370 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1371
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001372 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001373 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1374
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001376 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1377 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1378
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001379 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1380 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1381
138251degrees-cache-size <number>
1383 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1384 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1385 By default, this cache is disabled.
1386
1387 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001388 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1389
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001390wurfl-data-file <file path>
1391 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1392 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1393
1394 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1395 with USE_WURFL=1.
1396
1397wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1398 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1399 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1400 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1401
1402 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1403
1404 Valid WURFL properties are:
1405 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1406
1407 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1408 device.
1409
1410 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1411 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1412
1413 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1414 particular web request.
1415
1416 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1417 used Libwurfl API version.
1418
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001419 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1420 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1421
1422 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1423 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1424
1425 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1426
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001427 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1428 with USE_WURFL=1.
1429
1430wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1431 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1432 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1433
1434 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1435 with USE_WURFL=1.
1436
1437wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1438 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1439 thus before the chroot.
1440
1441 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1442 with USE_WURFL=1.
1443
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001444wurfl-cache-size <size>
1445 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1446 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001447 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001448 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001449
1450 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1451 with USE_WURFL=1.
1452
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001453strict-limits
1454 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1455 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1456 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1457 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1458 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1459 keyword.
1460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014613.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001462-----------------------
1463
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001464busy-polling
1465 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1466 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1467 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1468 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1469 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1470 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1471 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1472 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1473 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1474 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1475 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1476 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1477 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1478 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1479 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1480 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1481 "poll" pollers.
1482
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001483 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1484 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1485 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1486
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001487max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1488 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1489 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1490 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1491 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1492 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1493 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1494 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1495 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1496
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001497maxconn <number>
1498 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1499 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1500 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001501 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1502 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1503 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1504 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001505 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1506 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1507 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1508 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1509 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1510 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001511
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001512maxconnrate <number>
1513 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1514 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1515 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1516 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1517 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1518 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1519 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1520 fairness.
1521
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001522maxcomprate <number>
1523 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001524 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001525 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1526 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1527 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001528 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001529 default value.
1530
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001531maxcompcpuusage <number>
1532 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1533 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1534 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1535 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1536 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1537 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1538 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1539 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1540
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001541maxpipes <number>
1542 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1543 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1544 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1545 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1546 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1547 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1548
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001549maxsessrate <number>
1550 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1551 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1552 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1553 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1554 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1555 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1556 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1557 fairness.
1558
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001559maxsslconn <number>
1560 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1561 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1562 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1563 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1564 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1565 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1566 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001567 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1568 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1569 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1570 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1571 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1572 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1573 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001574
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001575maxsslrate <number>
1576 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1577 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1578 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1579 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1580 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1581 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1582 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1583 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1584 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1585 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1586
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001587maxzlibmem <number>
1588 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1589 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1590 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001591 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1592 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1593 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1594
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001595noepoll
1596 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1597 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001598 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001599
1600nokqueue
1601 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1602 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1603 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1604
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001605noevports
1606 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1607 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1608 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1609 also "nopoll".
1610
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611nopoll
1612 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1613 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001615 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1616 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001618nosplice
1619 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001620 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001621 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001622 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001623 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1624 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1625 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1626 "option splice-response".
1627
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001628nogetaddrinfo
1629 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1630 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1631
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001632noreuseport
1633 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1634 command line argument "-dR".
1635
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001636profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1637 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1638 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1639 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1640 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001641 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001642 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1643 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1644 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1645 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1646
1647 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1648 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1649 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1650 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1651 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001652 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1653 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1654 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1655 CLI.
1656
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001657spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001658 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1659 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1660 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1661 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1662 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1663 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001664
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001665ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001666 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001667 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001668 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1669 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1670 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1671 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1672 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001673 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1674 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001675 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1676 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1677 openssl configuration file uses:
1678 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1679
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001680ssl-mode-async
1681 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001682 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001683 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1684 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1685 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001686 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001687 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001688
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001689tune.buffers.limit <number>
1690 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1691 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1692 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1693 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1694 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001695 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001696 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1697 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1698 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1699 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1700 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1701 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1702 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1703 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1704 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1705
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001706tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1707 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1708 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1709 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1710 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1711
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001712tune.bufsize <number>
1713 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1714 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1715 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1716 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1717 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1718 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1719 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001720 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1721 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1722 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001723 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001724 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1725 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1726 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001727
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001728tune.chksize <number>
1729 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1730 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1731 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1732 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1733 checks whenever possible.
1734
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001735tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1736 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1737 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1738 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1739 this value. The default value is 1.
1740
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001741tune.fail-alloc
1742 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1743 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1744 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1745 gracefully.
1746
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001747tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1748 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1749 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1750 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1751 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1752 change it.
1753
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001754tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1755 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001756 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1757 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001758 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1759 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1760 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1761 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1762 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1763
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001764tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1765 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1766 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1767 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1768 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1769 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1770 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1771 recommended not to change this value.
1772
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001773tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1774 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1775 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1776 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1777 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1778 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1779 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1780 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1781
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001782tune.http.cookielen <number>
1783 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1784 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1785 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1786 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1787 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1788 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1789 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1790 to change this value.
1791
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001792tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1794 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001795 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001797 configuration directives too.
1798 The default value is 1024.
1799
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001800tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1801 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1802 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1803 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1804 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1805 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1806 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001807 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1808 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1809 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001810
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001811tune.idletimer <timeout>
1812 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1813 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1814 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1815 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1816 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1817 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001818 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001819 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001820 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1821
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001822tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1823 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1824 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1825 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1826 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1827 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1828 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1829 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1830 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1831 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1832
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001833tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1834 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001835 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001836 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1837 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001838 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001839 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1840 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1841
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001842tune.lua.maxmem
1843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1844 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1845 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1846 memory.
1847
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001848tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1849 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001850 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1851 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001852 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001853
1854tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1855 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1856 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1857 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1858 check servers.
1859
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001860tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1861 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1862 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1863 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001864 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001865
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001866tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001867 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1868 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1869 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1870 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1871 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1872 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1873 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1874 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1875 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1876 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001877
1878tune.maxpollevents <number>
1879 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1880 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1881 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1882 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1883 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1884
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001885tune.maxrewrite <number>
1886 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1887 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1888 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1889 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1890 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1891 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1892 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1893 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1894 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1895 bufsize.
1896
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001897tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1898 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1899 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1900 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1901 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1902 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1903 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1904 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1905 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1906 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001907 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1908 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001909 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1910 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1911 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1912 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1913 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1914 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1915 setting this parameter to 0.
1916
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001917tune.pipesize <number>
1918 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1919 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1920 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1921 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1922 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1923 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1924
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001925tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1926 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1927 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1928 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1929 default is 20.
1930
1931tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1932 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1933 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1934 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1935 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1936 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1937 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001938 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001939
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001940tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1941tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1942 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1943 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1944 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001945 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001947 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1948 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1949
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001950tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001951 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001952 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1953 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1954 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1955 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1956
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001957tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001958 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001959 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1960 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1961
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001962tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1963tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1964 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1965 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1966 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001967 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001968 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001969 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1970 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1971 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1972 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1973 notifying haproxy again.
1974
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001975tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001976 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1977 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1978 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001979 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001980 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001981 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001982 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1983 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1984 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001985 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1986 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001987
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001988tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001989 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001990 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1991 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1992 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1993 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1994 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1995
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001996tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1997 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001998 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001999 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2000 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2001 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2002 being used for too long.
2003
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002004tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2005 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2006 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2007 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2008 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2009 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2010 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2011 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2012 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2013 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2014 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002015 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002016 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002017
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002018tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2019 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2020 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2021 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2022 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2023 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2024 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2025 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002026 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2027 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002028
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002029tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2030 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2031 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2032 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2033 1000 entries.
2034
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002035tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2036 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2037 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2038 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2039
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002040tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002041tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002042tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2043tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2044tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002045 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2046 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2047 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2048 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2049 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2050 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2051 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2052 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002053
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002054 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2055 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2056 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2057 all available space is consumed.
2058 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2059 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2060 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002061
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002062tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2063 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002064 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002065 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002066 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002067 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2068
2069tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2070 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2071 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002072 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2073 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020753.3. Debugging
2076--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002077
2078debug
2079 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2080 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2081 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2082 system startup.
2083
2084quiet
2085 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2086 line argument "-q".
2087
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020893.4. Userlists
2090--------------
2091It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2092http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2093it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2094
2095userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002096 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002097 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2098
2099group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002100 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002101 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2102 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2103
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002104user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2105 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002106 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2107 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002108 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2109 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2110 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2111 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002112
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002113 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2114 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2115 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2116 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2117 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2118 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2119 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2120 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2121 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002122
2123 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002124 userlist L1
2125 group G1 users tiger,scott
2126 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002128 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2129 user scott insecure-password elgato
2130 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002131
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002132 userlist L2
2133 group G1
2134 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002135
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002136 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2137 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2138 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002139
2140 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002141
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002142
21433.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002144----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002145It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2146several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2147instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2148values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2149automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2150In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2151using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2152tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2153reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2154Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2155that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2156each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002159 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002160 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2161
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002162bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2163 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2164 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2165
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002166disabled
2167 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2168 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2169 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2170
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002171default-bind [param*]
2172 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2173
2174default-server [param*]
2175 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2176
2177 Arguments:
2178 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2179 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2180 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2181 details.
2182
2183
2184 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2185
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002186enable
2187 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2188
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002189log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2190 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2191 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2192 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2193 more details.
2194
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002195peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002196 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2197 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2198 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2199 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2200 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2201 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2202
2203 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2204 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2205
2206 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2207 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2208 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2209 across all peers.
2210
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002211 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2212 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002213
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002214 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2215 "server" keyword explanation below).
2216
2217server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002218 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002219 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2220 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2221 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2222 of this "peers" section).
2223 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2224
2225
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002226 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002227 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002228 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002229 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2230 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2231 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002232
2233 backend mybackend
2234 mode tcp
2235 balance roundrobin
2236 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2237 stick on src
2238
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002239 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2240 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002241
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002242 Example:
2243 peers mypeers
2244 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2245 default-server ssl verify none
2246 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2247 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002248
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002249
2250table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2251 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2252
2253 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2254 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002255 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002256 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2257 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2258 "stick-table" keyword).
2259
2260 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2261 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2262 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2263 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2264 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2265 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2266 of the stick-table name as follows:
2267
2268 peers mypeers
2269 peer A ...
2270 peer B ...
2271 table t1 ...
2272
2273 frontend fe1
2274 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2275
2276 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2277 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2278
2279 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2280 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2281 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2282 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2283 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2284 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2285 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2286
2287 peers mypeers
2288 peer A ...
2289 peer B ...
2290 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2291
2292 backend t1
2293 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2294
2295 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2296 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2297 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2298
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022993.6. Mailers
2300------------
2301It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2302If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2303in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2304
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002305mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002306 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2307 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2308
2309mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2310 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2311
2312 Example:
2313 mailers mymailers
2314 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2315 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2316
2317 backend mybackend
2318 mode tcp
2319 balance roundrobin
2320
2321 email-alert mailers mymailers
2322 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2323 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2324
2325 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2326 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2327
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002328timeout mail <time>
2329 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2330 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2331 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2332 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2333
2334 Example:
2335 mailers mymailers
2336 timeout mail 20s
2337 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002338
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023393.7. Programs
2340-------------
2341In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2342master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2343managed the same way as the workers.
2344
2345During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2346sequence as a worker:
2347
2348 - the master is re-executed
2349 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2350 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2351 instance of the program
2352
2353During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2354
2355program <name>
2356 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2357 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2358 the management guide).
2359
2360command <command> [arguments*]
2361 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2362 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2363 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2364 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2365
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002366user <user name>
2367 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2368 See also "group".
2369
2370group <group name>
2371 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2372 See also "user".
2373
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002374option start-on-reload
2375no option start-on-reload
2376 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2377 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2378 program section.
2379
2380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023814. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002382----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002384Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002385 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002386 - frontend <name>
2387 - backend <name>
2388 - listen <name>
2389
2390A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2391its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2392section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002393section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002394
2395A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2396connections.
2397
2398A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2399to forward incoming connections.
2400
2401A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2402parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2405'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2406case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2407
2408Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2409logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2410proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2411However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2412name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2413
2414Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2415and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002416bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2418modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2419arbitrary criteria.
2420
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002421In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2422a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002423the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002424
2425 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2426 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2427 between responses and new requests.
2428
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002429 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2430 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2431 client-facing connection remains open.
2432
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002433 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2434 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002435
2436The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2437frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2438following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002439weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002440
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002441 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002442
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002443 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2444 ----+-----+-----+----
2445 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2446 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002447 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2448 ----+-----+-----+----
2449 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002450
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2454--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002456The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2457limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2458they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2459limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002460marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002461option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002462and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2463with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2464specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002466
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002467 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2468------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2469acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470backlog X X X -
2471balance X - X X
2472bind - X X -
2473bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002474capture cookie - X X -
2475capture request header - X X -
2476capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002477compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002478cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002479declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480default-server X - X X
2481default_backend X X X -
2482description - X X X
2483disabled X X X X
2484dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002485email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002486email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002487email-alert mailers X X X X
2488email-alert myhostname X X X X
2489email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490enabled X X X X
2491errorfile X X X X
2492errorloc X X X X
2493errorloc302 X X X X
2494-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2495errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002496force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002497filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002498fullconn X - X X
2499grace X X X X
2500hash-type X - X X
2501http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002502http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002503http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002504http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002505http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002506http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002507http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002509ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002510load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002511log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002512log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002513log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002514log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002515max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002516maxconn X X X -
2517mode X X X X
2518monitor fail - X X -
2519monitor-net X X X -
2520monitor-uri X X X -
2521option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2522option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2523option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2524option allbackups (*) X - X X
2525option checkcache (*) X - X X
2526option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2527option contstats (*) X X X -
2528option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2529option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002530-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2531option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002532option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2533option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002534option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002535option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002536option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002537option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002538option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2540option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2541option httpchk X - X X
2542option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002543option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002544option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002545option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002546option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002547option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002548option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2549option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2550option logasap (*) X X X -
2551option mysql-check X - X X
2552option nolinger (*) X X X X
2553option originalto X X X X
2554option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002555option pgsql-check X - X X
2556option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002558option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002559option smtpchk X - X X
2560option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2561option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2562option splice-request (*) X X X X
2563option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002564option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002565option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2566option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2567-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002568option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2570option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2571option tcpka X X X X
2572option tcplog X X X X
2573option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002574external-check command X - X X
2575external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002576persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2577rate-limit sessions X X X -
2578redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002579-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002581retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002582server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002583server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002584server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002586stats admin - X X X
2587stats auth X X X X
2588stats enable X X X X
2589stats hide-version X X X X
2590stats http-request - X X X
2591stats realm X X X X
2592stats refresh X X X X
2593stats scope X X X X
2594stats show-desc X X X X
2595stats show-legends X X X X
2596stats show-node X X X X
2597stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002598-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2599stick match - - X X
2600stick on - - X X
2601stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002602stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002603stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002604tcp-check connect - - X X
2605tcp-check expect - - X X
2606tcp-check send - - X X
2607tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002608tcp-request connection - X X -
2609tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002610tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002611tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002612tcp-response content - - X X
2613tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002614timeout check X - X X
2615timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002616timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002617timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002618timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2619timeout http-request X X X X
2620timeout queue X - X X
2621timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002622timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002624timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002625transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002626unique-id-format X X X -
2627unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002628use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002629use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002630use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2632 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026354.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2636---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637
2638This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2639
2640
2641acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2642 Declare or complete an access list.
2643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2644 no | yes | yes | yes
2645 Example:
2646 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2647 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2648 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002650 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002651
2652
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002653backlog <conns>
2654 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 yes | yes | yes | no
2657 Arguments :
2658 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2659 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002660 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002661
2662 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2663 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2664 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2665 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2666 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2667 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2668 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2669 backlog parameter.
2670
2671 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2672 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2673 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2674
2675 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2676
2677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002679balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2682 yes | no | yes | yes
2683 Arguments :
2684 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2685 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2686 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2687 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2688
2689 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2690 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2691 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2692 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002693 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002694 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002695 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2696 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2697 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2698 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2699 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2700 it, so that you don't worry.
2701
2702 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2703 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2704 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2705 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2706 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2707 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2708 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2709 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002710
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002711 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2712 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2713 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2714 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2715 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2716 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2717 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2718 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2719
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002720 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002721 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002722 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2723 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002724 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002725 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2726 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2727 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2728 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2729 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002730 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2731 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2732 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2733 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2734 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2735 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2738 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2739 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2740 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2741 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2742 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2743 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2744 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002745 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002747 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2748 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2749 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002750
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002751 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2752 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2753 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2754 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2755 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2756 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2757 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2758 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2759 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2760 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2761 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2762 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002764 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002765 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2766 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2767 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2768 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2769 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2770 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2771 URIs start with a leading "/".
2772
2773 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2774 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2775 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2776 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002779 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2780
2781 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002782 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2783 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002784 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2785 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2786 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2787 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002788 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002789 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2790 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002791
2792 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2793 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2794 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2795 server will receive the request.
2796
2797 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2798 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2799 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2800 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2801 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002802 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2803 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2804 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002806 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2807 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2808 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2809 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2810 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002812 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002813 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2814 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2815 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2816
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002817 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2818 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2819 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2820
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002821 random
2822 random(<draws>)
2823 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002824 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2825 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2826 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2827 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002828 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2829 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2830 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2831 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2832 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2833 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2834 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2835 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2836 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2837 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2838 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2839 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2840 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2841 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2842 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2843 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2844 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2845 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2846 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2847 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002848
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002849 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002850 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002851 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2852 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2853 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2854 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2855 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2856 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002857 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002858 used instead.
2859
2860 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2861 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2862 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2863 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2864
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002865 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2866 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2867 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2868
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002869 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002872 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2873 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002874
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002875 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2876 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2877 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002879 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002880 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002881 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2882 NTLM relies on.
2883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884 Examples :
2885 balance roundrobin
2886 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002887 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002888 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2889 balance hdr(host)
2890 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002891
2892 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2893 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002895 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002896 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2897 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2898 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002899 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002900
2901 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2902 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2903 defaults to 16 kB.
2904
2905 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2906 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2907
2908 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2909 Round Robin.
2910
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002911 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002912 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2913 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2914 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2915
2916 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2917
2918 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002919 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002920 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2921 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2922 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002924 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
2926
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002927bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2928bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2931 no | yes | yes | no
2932 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002933 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2934 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2935 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2936 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002937 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002938 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2939 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2940 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2941 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2942 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2943 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2944 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002945 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2946 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2947 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2948 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2949 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2950 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2951 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002952 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2953 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2954 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002955 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2956 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2957 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2958 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002959 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2960 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2961 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002962
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002963 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2964 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002965 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2966 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2967 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002968 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2969 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2970 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2971 the range.
2972
2973 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2974 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2975 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2976 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2977 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2978 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2979 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002980 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002981 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002982
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002983 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002984 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002985 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2986 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2987 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2988 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2989 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2990 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2991
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002992 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2993 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2994 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2995 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2998 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2999 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3000 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3001 in a frontend.
3002
3003 Example :
3004 listen http_proxy
3005 bind :80,:443
3006 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003007 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003009 listen http_https_proxy
3010 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003011 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003012
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003013 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3014 bind ipv6@:80
3015 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3016 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3017
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003018 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003019 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003020
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003021 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3022 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3023 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3024 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3025 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3026
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003027 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003028 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003029
3030
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003031bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003032 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3034 yes | yes | yes | yes
3035 Arguments :
3036 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3037 may be used to override a default value.
3038
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003039 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003040 option may be combined with other numbers.
3041
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003042 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003043 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3044 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3045 missing from all processes.
3046
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003047 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003048 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003049 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3050 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3051 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3052 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3053 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003054 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003055
3056 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3057 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3058 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3059 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3060 and 'even' instances.
3061
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003062 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3063 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3064 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3065 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003066
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003067 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3068 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3069
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003070 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3071 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3072 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3073
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003074 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3075 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3076
3077 Example :
3078 listen app_ip1
3079 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003080 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081
3082 listen app_ip2
3083 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003084 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003085
3086 listen management
3087 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003088 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003089
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003090 listen management
3091 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3092 bind-process 1-4
3093
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003094 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003095
3096
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003097capture cookie <name> len <length>
3098 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 no | yes | yes | no
3101 Arguments :
3102 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3103 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3104 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3105 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003106 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003107
3108 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3109 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3110 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3111 right if it exceeds <length>.
3112
3113 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3114 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3115 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3116 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3117
3118 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3119 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3120 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3121
3122 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3123 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3124 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003125 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3126 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3127 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
3129 Example:
3130 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3131
3132 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003133 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134
3135
3136capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3139 no | yes | yes | no
3140 Arguments :
3141 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003142 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3144 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3145 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3146
3147 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3148 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3149 it exceeds <length>.
3150
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003151 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003152 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3153 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003154 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3155 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3156 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3157 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003158 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003159 environments to find where the request came from.
3160
3161 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3162 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3163 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3164 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003166 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3167 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3168 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3169 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3170 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171
3172 Example:
3173 capture request header Host len 15
3174 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003175 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003177 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003178 about logging.
3179
3180
3181capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3184 no | yes | yes | no
3185 Arguments :
3186 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003187 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3189 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3190 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3191
3192 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3193 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3194 it exceeds <length>.
3195
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003196 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003197 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3198 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3199 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003200 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3201 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3202 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3203 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003205 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3206 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3207 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3208 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3209 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003210
3211 Example:
3212 capture response header Content-length len 9
3213 capture response header Location len 15
3214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003215 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003216 about logging.
3217
3218
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003219compression algo <algorithm> ...
3220compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003221compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003222 Enable HTTP compression.
3223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3224 yes | yes | yes | yes
3225 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003226 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3227 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3228 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3229
3230 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003231 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3232 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3233 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003234
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003235 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003236 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003237
3238 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3239 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3240 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3241 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3242 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003243 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003244
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003245 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3246 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3247 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3248 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3249 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3250 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3251 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003252 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003253
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003254 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003255 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003256 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3257 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3258 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3259 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3260 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003261
3262 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3263 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3264 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3265 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3266 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003267 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3268 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3269 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3270 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3271 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003272 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3273 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003274
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003275 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003276 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3277 "Accept-Encoding" header
3278 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003279 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003280 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3281 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3282 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3283 "multipart"
3284 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3285 header
3286 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3287 and later
3288 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3289 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003290 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003291
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003292 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003293
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294 Examples :
3295 compression algo gzip
3296 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003298
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003299cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003300 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3301 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003302 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3305 yes | no | yes | yes
3306 Arguments :
3307 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3308 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3309 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3310 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3311 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3312 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003313 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003314 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3315 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3316
3317 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3318 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3319 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3320 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3321 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3322 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003323 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3324 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003325 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003326 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3327 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328
3329 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003330 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003331
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003332 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003333 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003334 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003335 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003336 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3337 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3338 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3339 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3340 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3341 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3342 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003343
3344 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3345 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3346 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3347 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3348 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3349 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3350 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3351 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3352 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003353 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003354 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3355 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3356 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003357
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003358 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3359 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3360 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003361 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3362 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3363 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3364 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003365 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3366 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3367 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
3369 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3370 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3371 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3372 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3373 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3374 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3375 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3376 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3377 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3378
3379 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3380 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3381 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3382 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3383 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3384 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3385 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3386 persistence cookie in the cache.
3387 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3388
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003389 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3390 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3391 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3392 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3393 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003394 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003395 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3396 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3397 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3398 they logout.
3399
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003400 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3401 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3402 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3403 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3404
3405 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3406 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3407 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3408 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3409 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3410 this attribute.
3411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003412 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003413 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003414 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3415 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3416 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3417 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3418 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3419 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003420
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003421 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3422 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3423 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3424 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3425 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3426 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3427 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3428 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003429 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003430 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3431 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3432 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3433 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3434 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3435 the site.
3436
3437 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3438 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3439 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3440 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3441 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3442 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3443 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3444 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3445 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3446 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3447 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3448 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3449 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003450 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003451 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3452 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3453
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003454 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3455 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3456 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3457 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3458 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3459 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3462 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3463 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3464 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003465
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466 Examples :
3467 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3468 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3469 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003470 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003471
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003472 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003474
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003475declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3476 Declares a capture slot.
3477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3478 no | yes | yes | no
3479 Arguments:
3480 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3481
3482 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3483 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3484 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3485 for use in the response.
3486
3487 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003488 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003489 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3490
3491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003492default-server [param*]
3493 Change default options for a server in a backend
3494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | no | yes | yes
3496 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003497 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3498 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3499 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3500 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003501
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003502 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003503 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3504
3505 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003507
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003508default_backend <backend>
3509 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3511 yes | yes | yes | no
3512 Arguments :
3513 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3514
3515 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3516 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3517 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3518 will catch all undetermined requests.
3519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520 Example :
3521
3522 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3523 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3524 default_backend dynamic
3525
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003526 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003529description <string>
3530 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 no | yes | yes | yes
3533 Arguments : string
3534
3535 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3536 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3537 it describes.
3538 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3539
3540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003541disabled
3542 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3544 yes | yes | yes | yes
3545 Arguments : none
3546
3547 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3548 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3549 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3550 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3551 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3552 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3553 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3554
3555 See also : "enabled"
3556
3557
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003558dispatch <address>:<port>
3559 Set a default server address
3560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003562 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003563
3564 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3565 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3566 during start-up.
3567
3568 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3569 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3570 possible with normal servers.
3571
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003572 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003573 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3574 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3575 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3576 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3577
3578 See also : "server"
3579
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003580
3581dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3582 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3584 yes | no | yes | yes
3585 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3586
3587 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003588 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003589 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3590 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003591 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003592 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003593
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594enabled
3595 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3597 yes | yes | yes | yes
3598 Arguments : none
3599
3600 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3601 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3602
3603 See also : "disabled"
3604
3605
3606errorfile <code> <file>
3607 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3609 yes | yes | yes | yes
3610 Arguments :
3611 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003612 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3613 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003614
3615 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003616 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003618 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3619 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620
3621 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3622 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3623 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3624
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003625 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003627 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3628 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3629 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3630 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3631
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003632 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3633 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003634 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003635 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3636 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3637 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3640 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3641 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003642 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003643 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3644
3645 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3646
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003647 Example :
3648 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003649 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003650 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3651 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653
3654errorloc <code> <url>
3655errorloc302 <code> <url>
3656 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3658 yes | yes | yes | yes
3659 Arguments :
3660 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003661 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3662 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003663
3664 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3665 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3666 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3667 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003668 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003669
3670 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3671 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3672 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3673
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003674 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3675
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003676 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3677 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3678 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3679 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003680 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003681 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3682 request.
3683
3684 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3685
3686
3687errorloc303 <code> <url>
3688 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | yes | yes | yes
3691 Arguments :
3692 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003693 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3694 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003695
3696 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3697 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3698 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3699 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003700 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003701
3702 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3703 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3704 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3705
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003706 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003708 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3709 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3710 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3711 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003712 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003713
3714 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3715
3716
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003717email-alert from <emailaddr>
3718 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003719 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | yes | yes | yes
3722
3723 Arguments :
3724
3725 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3726
3727 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3728 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3729
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003730 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003731 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3732 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003733
3734
3735email-alert level <level>
3736 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3737 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | yes
3740
3741 Arguments :
3742
3743 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3744 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3745 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3746
3747 By default level is alert
3748
3749 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3750 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3751 for the proxy.
3752
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003753 Alerts are sent when :
3754
3755 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3756 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3757 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3758 is notice or lower
3759 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3760 and a health check status update occurs
3761
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003762 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3763 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003764 section 3.6 about mailers.
3765
3766
3767email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3768 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3769 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | yes
3771
3772 Arguments :
3773
3774 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3775
3776 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3777 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3778
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003779 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3780 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003781
3782
3783email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3784 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3785 mailers.
3786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 yes | yes | yes | yes
3788
3789 Arguments :
3790
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003791 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003792
3793 By default the systems hostname is used.
3794
3795 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3796 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3797 for the proxy.
3798
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003799 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3800 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003801
3802
3803email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003804 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003805 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3806 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 yes | yes | yes | yes
3808
3809 Arguments :
3810
3811 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3812
3813 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3814 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3815
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003816 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003817 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3818
3819
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003820force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3821 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3822 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003823 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003824
3825 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3826 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3827 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3828 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3829 marked down for maintenance operations.
3830
3831 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3832 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3833 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3834 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3835 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3836 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3837 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3838 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3839 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3840
3841 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3842 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3843 is used.
3844
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003845 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003846 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003847
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003848
3849filter <name> [param*]
3850 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3852 no | yes | yes | yes
3853 Arguments :
3854 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3855 referenced in section 9.
3856
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003857 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003858 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003859 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3860 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003861
3862 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3863 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3864
3865 Example:
3866 listen
3867 bind *:80
3868
3869 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3870 filter compression
3871 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3872
3873 compression algo gzip
3874 compression offload
3875
3876 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3877
3878 See also : section 9.
3879
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003881fullconn <conns>
3882 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3884 yes | no | yes | yes
3885 Arguments :
3886 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3887 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3888
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003889 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003891 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003892 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3893 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3894 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3895 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3896 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003897 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003898
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003899 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3900 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003901 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3902 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3903 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003904
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003905 Example :
3906 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3907 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3908 # connections.
3909 backend dynamic
3910 fullconn 10000
3911 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3912 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3913
3914 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3915
3916
3917grace <time>
3918 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003920 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003921 Arguments :
3922 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3923 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3924 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3925
3926 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3927 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003928 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003929 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3930
3931 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3932 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3933 simplify it.
3934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003936hash-balance-factor <factor>
3937 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3939 yes | no | no | yes
3940 Arguments :
3941 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3942 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003943 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003944
3945 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3946 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3947 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3948 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3949 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3950 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3951 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3952
3953 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3954 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3955 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3956 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3957 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3958
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003959 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3960 consistent hashing mechanism.
3961
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003962 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3963
3964
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003965hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003966 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | no | yes | yes
3969 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003970 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3971 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003972
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003973 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3974 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3975 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3976 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3977 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3978 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3979 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3980 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3981 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3982 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003983
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003984 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3985 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3986 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3987 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3988 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3989 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3990 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3991 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3992 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3993 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3994 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3995 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3996 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003997 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3998 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003999
4000 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4001
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004002 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004003 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4004 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4005 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004006 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4007 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4008 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004009
4010 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4011 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004012 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4013 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4014 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4015 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4016
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004017 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4018 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4019 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4020 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4021 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4022 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4023 parameter.
4024
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004025 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4026 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4027 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4028 used on strings.
4029
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004030 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4031
4032 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4033 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4034 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4035 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4036 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4037 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4038 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4039 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4040 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4041 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4042 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4043 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004044
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004045 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4046 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4047 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004048
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004049 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004050
4051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004052http-check disable-on-404
4053 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004055 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004056 Arguments : none
4057
4058 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4059 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4060 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4061 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4062 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4063 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4064 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4065 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004066 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4067 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4068 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4069
4070 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4071
4072
4073http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004074 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004076 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004077 Arguments :
4078 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4079 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004080 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4082 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4083 details on the supported keywords.
4084
4085 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4086 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4087 with the usual backslash ('\').
4088
4089 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4090 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4091 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4092 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4093 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4094
4095 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004096 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004097 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4098 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4099 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4100
4101 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004102 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004103 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4104 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4105 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4106 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4107
4108 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004109 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004110 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4111 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4112 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4113 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4114 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004115 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004116 trace).
4117
4118 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004119 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004120 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4121 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4122 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4123 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4124 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004125 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004126
4127 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4128 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4129 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4130 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4131 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4132 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4133 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4134 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4135
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004136 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4137 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4138 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4139
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004140 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4141 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4142
4143 Examples :
4144 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004145 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004146
4147 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004148 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004149
4150 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004151 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004152
4153 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004154 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004155
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004156 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004157
4158
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004159http-check send-state
4160 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4162 yes | no | yes | yes
4163 Arguments : none
4164
4165 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4166 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4167 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4168 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4169 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4170
4171 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4172 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4173 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4174 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4175 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004176 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4177 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4178 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4179
4180 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4181 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4182 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4183
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004184 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4185 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4186 checked in multiple backends.
4187
4188 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4189 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4190
4191 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4192 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4193 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4194 one fails.
4195
4196 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4197 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4198 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4199
4200 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4201 server's queue.
4202
4203 Example of a header received by the application server :
4204 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4205 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4206
4207 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209
4210http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004211 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4212
4213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4214 no | yes | yes | yes
4215
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004216 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4217 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4218 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4219 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4220 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4223 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227 Example:
4228 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4229 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4230 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232 http-request allow if nagios
4233 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4234 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4235 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004237 Example:
4238 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4239 acl add path /addacl
4240 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4245 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 Example:
4248 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4249 acl setmap path /setmap
4250 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004254 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4255 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4258 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004260http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4263 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4264 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4265 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4266 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4267 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4268 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4269 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004271http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4274 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4275 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4276 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4277 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4278 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4279 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4280 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4285 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004286
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4291 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4292 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4293 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4294 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296 Example:
4297 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4298 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004299
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004300http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004301
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004302 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4305 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4308 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4309 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4310 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4311 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4312 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4313 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4314 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4315 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004317 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4318 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4319 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4320 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4321 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4322 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4327 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4328 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4329 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4330 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4331 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004333http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004339 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4340 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4341 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4342 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4343 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4344 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004346http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4349 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4350 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4351 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4352 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004353
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004354http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4355 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4356 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4357 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4358
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004359http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4360
4361 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4362 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4363 pointed by <resolvers>.
4364 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4365 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4366 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4367 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4368 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4369 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4370 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4371 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4372 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4373 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4374 to 0.0.0.0.
4375
4376 Example:
4377 resolvers mydns
4378 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4379 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4380 timeout retry 1s
4381 hold valid 10s
4382 hold nx 3s
4383 hold other 3s
4384 hold obsolete 0s
4385 accepted_payload_size 8192
4386
4387 frontend fe
4388 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4389 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4390 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4391
4392 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4393 # which mean DNS resolution error
4394 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4395
4396 default_backend be
4397
4398 backend b_503
4399 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4400 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4401 # 503 error page to end users
4402
4403 backend be
4404 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4405 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4406 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4407 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4408 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4409
4410 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4411 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4412
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004413http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4414
4415 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4416 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4417 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4418 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004419 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4420 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004421
4422 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4427 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4428 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4429 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4430 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4435 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4436 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4437 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004442 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4443 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4444 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4445 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4446 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4447 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004448
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004449 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4450 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4451 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4452 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4453 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004454
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004455 Example:
4456 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4457
4458 # applied to:
4459 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4460
4461 # outputs:
4462 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4463
4464 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004465
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004466 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4467
4468 # applied to:
4469 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004470
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004471 # outputs:
4472 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004473
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004474http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4475 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4476
4477 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4478 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4479 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4480 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4481
4482 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4483 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4484 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4485
4486 Example:
4487 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4488 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4489
4490 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4491 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4492
4493 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4494 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4495 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4496 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4497
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004498http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4499 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4500
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004501 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4502 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4503 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4504 against.
4505
4506 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4507 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4508 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004509
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004510 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4511 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4512 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4513 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4514 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4515 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4516 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4517 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4518 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004519 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4520 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004521
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004522 Example:
4523 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4524 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004525
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004526 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4527 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004529http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4530 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004531
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004532 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4533 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4534 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4535 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004536
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004537 Example:
4538 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004539
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004540 # applied to:
4541 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004542
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004543 # outputs:
4544 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4547http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4550 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4551 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004552
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004553http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004555
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004556 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4557 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4558 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4559 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004563 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4564 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4565 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4566 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4567 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 Arguments:
4570 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4571 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 Example:
4574 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4575 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4578 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4583 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4584 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 Arguments:
4587 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4588 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004590 Example:
4591 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4592 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004594 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4595 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4596 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004600 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4601 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4602 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4603 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4604 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 Example:
4607 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4608 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4609 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4610 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4611 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4612 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4613 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4614 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4615 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4620 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4621 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4622 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4623 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4626 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004628 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4629 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4630 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4631 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4632 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4633 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4634 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4635 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4636 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004638http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004640 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4641 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4642 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4643 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4644 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4645 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4646 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4651 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4652 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4657 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4658 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4659 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4660 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4661 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4662 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4663 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004667 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4668 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4669 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4670 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4671 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4672 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 Example :
4675 # prepend the host name before the path
4676 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004680 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4681 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4682 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4683 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4684 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004686http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4689 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4690 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4691 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4692 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4693 values have higher priority.
4694 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4695 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4696 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4697 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4698 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004700http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004702 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4703 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4704 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4705 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4706 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4707 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4708 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004710 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004711
4712 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004713 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4714 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4717 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4718 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4719 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4720 privacy.
4721
4722 Arguments :
4723 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4724 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004725
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004726 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004727 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4728 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4729
4730 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4731 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4732
4733http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4734
4735 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4736 expression.
4737
4738 Arguments:
4739 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4740 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004741
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004742 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4744 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4745
4746 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4747 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4748 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4749
4750http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4751
4752 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4753 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4754 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4755 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4756 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4757 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4758 information from the request.
4759
4760 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4761
4762http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4763
4764 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4765 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4766 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4767 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4768 path and the query string.
4769 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4770
4771http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4772
4773 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4774 inline.
4775
4776 Arguments:
4777 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4778 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4779 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4780 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4781 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4782 (request and response)
4783 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4784 processing
4785 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4786 processing
4787 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4788 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4789 and '_'.
4790
4791 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4792 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004793
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004794 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004795 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004797http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4798 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004800 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4801 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4802 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4803 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4804 agent name must be used.
4805
4806 Arguments:
4807 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4808
4809 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4810 configuration.
4811
4812http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4813
4814 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4815 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4816 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4817 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4818 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4819 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4820 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4821 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4822 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4823 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4824 action.
4825 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4826 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4827 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4828 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4829 you fully understand how it works.
4830
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004831http-request strict-mode { on | off }
4832
4833 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4834 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4835 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4836 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4837 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4838 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
4839 processing.
4840
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01004841 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004842 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4843 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
4844 rules evaluation.
4845
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004846http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4847
4848 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4849 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4850 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4851 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4852 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4853 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4854 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4855 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4856 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4857 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4858 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4859 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4860 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4861
4862http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4863http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4864http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4865
4866 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4867 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4868 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4869 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4870 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4871 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4872 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4873 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4874 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4875 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4876 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4877 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4878
4879 Arguments :
4880 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4881 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4882 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4883 select which table entry to update the counters.
4884
4885 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4886 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4887 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4888 that table until the session ends.
4889
4890 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4891 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4892 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4893 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4894 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4895 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4896 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4897 useful information.
4898
4899 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4900 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4901 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4902 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4903 checks that make use of it.
4904
4905http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4906
4907 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004908
4909 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004910 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004911
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004912http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4913
4914 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4915 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4916 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4917 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4918 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4919 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4920
4921 Arguments :
4922 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4923
4924 Example:
4925 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004927http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004929 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4930 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4931 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004932
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004934http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004935 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4936
4937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4938 no | yes | yes | yes
4939
4940 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4941 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4942 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4943 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4944 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4945 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4948 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004952 Example:
4953 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004955 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004957 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4958 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960 Example:
4961 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004963 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004965 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4966 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004968 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4969 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004971http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4974 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4975 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4976 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4977 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4978 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4979 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4980 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4985 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4986 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4987 example, or to pass some internal information.
4988 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4989 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4990 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004991
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004992http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004993
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004994 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4995 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004996
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004997http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004998
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004999 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005001http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5004 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5005 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5006 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5007 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5008 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5009 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005011 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5012 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5013 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5014 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5015 keyword.
5016 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5017 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5022 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5023 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5024 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5025 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5026 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005028http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005032http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5035 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5036 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5037 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5038 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5039 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005043 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5044 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005048 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5049 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5050 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5051 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5052 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5053 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005055http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5056 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005057
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005058 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5059 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005061 Example:
5062 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064 # applied to:
5065 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 # outputs:
5068 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005070 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005072http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5073 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005074
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005075 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005076 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 Example:
5079 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081 # applied to:
5082 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005084 # outputs:
5085 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005087http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5088http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005090 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5091 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5092 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005093
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005094http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5095 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005096
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005097 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5098 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5099 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5100 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005102http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005104 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5105 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5106 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5107 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5108 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005110 Arguments:
5111 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005113 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5114 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5119 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5120 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005122http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5123
5124 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5125 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5126 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5127 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5128 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5129
5130http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5131
5132 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5133 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5134 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5135 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5136 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5137 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5138 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5139 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5140 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5141
5142http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5143
5144 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5145 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5146 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5147 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5148 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5149 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5150 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5151
5152http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5153
5154 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5155 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5156 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5157 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5158 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5159 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5160 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5161 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5162
5163http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5164 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5165
5166 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5167 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5168 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5169 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005170
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005171 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005172 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5173 http-response set-status 431
5174 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5175 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005177http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005179 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5180 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5181 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5182 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5183 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5184 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5185 based on some information from the request.
5186
5187 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5188
5189http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5190
5191 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5192 inline.
5193
5194 Arguments:
5195 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5196 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5197 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5198 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5199 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5200 (request and response)
5201 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5202 processing
5203 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5204 processing
5205 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5206 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5207 and '_'.
5208
5209 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5210 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005211
5212 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005213 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005215http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005217 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5218 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5219 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5220 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5221 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5222 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5223 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5224 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5225 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5226 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5227 action.
5228 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5229 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5230 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5231 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5232 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005233
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005234http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5235
5236 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5237 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5238 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5239 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5240 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5241 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5242 processing.
5243
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005244 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005245 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5246 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5247 rules evaluation.
5248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005249http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5250http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5251http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005252
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005253 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5254 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5255 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5256 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5257 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5258 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5259
5260http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5261
5262 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5263 about <var-name>.
5264
5265 Example:
5266 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5267
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005268
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005269http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5270 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5271
5272 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5273 yes | no | yes | yes
5274
5275 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005276 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5277 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5278 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005279
5280 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5281
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005282 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5283 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5284 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5285 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5286 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5287 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5288 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5289 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5290 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5291 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005292
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005293 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5294 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5295 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5296 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5297 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5298 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5299 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5300 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005301
5302 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5303 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5304 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5305 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5306 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5307 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5308 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5309 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005310 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005311 downsides of rare connection failures.
5312
5313 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5314 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5315 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5316 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5317 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5318 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005319 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005320 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5321 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5322 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5323 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5324 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5325
5326 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005327 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5328 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5329 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005330
5331 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005332 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005333
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005334 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5335 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005336
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005337 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005338
5339 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5340 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5341 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5342
5343 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5344
5345
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005346http-send-name-header [<header>]
5347 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005348 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5349 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005350 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005351 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5352
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005353 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5354 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5355 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5356 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5357 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5358 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5359 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5360 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5361 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5362 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5363 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5364 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5365 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5366 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5367 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5368 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005369
5370 See also : "server"
5371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005372id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005373 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5375 no | yes | yes | yes
5376 Arguments : none
5377
5378 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5379 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5380 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005381
5382
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005383ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5384 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005386 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005387
5388 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5389 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5390 and running).
5391
5392 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5393 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5394 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005395 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005396 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5397
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005398 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5399 "unless" condition is met.
5400
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005401 Example:
5402 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5403 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5404 ignore-persist if url_static
5405
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005406 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5407
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005408load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5409 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5410 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5411 yes | no | yes | yes
5412
5413 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5414 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5415 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005416 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005417 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5418 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5419 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5420 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5421
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005422 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005423 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005424 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005425
5426 Arguments:
5427 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5428 named "server-state-file".
5429
5430 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5431 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5432 name is used as a file name.
5433
5434 none don't load any stat for this backend
5435
5436 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005437 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5438 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5439 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005440 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005441 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005442
5443 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5444 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5445
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005446 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005447
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005448 global
5449 stats socket /tmp/socket
5450 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005451
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005452 defaults
5453 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005454
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005455 backend bk
5456 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5457 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005458
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005459
5460 Then one can run :
5461
5462 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5463
5464 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5465
5466 1
5467 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5468 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5469 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5470
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005471 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005472
5473 global
5474 stats socket /tmp/socket
5475 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5476
5477 defaults
5478 load-server-state-from-file local
5479
5480 backend bk
5481 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5482 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5483
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005484
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005485 Then one can run :
5486
5487 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5488
5489 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5490
5491 1
5492 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5493 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5494 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5495
5496 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5497 "show servers state"
5498
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005499
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005500log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005501log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5502 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005503no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005504 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5506 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005507
5508 Prefix :
5509 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5510 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5511 prefix does not allow arguments.
5512
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005513 Arguments :
5514 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5515 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5516 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5517 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5518 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5519 parameter.
5520
5521 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5522 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5523
5524 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5525 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5526 standard syslog port).
5527
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005528 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5529 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5530 standard syslog port).
5531
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5533 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5534 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005535 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005536
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005537 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5538 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5539 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5540 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5541 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5542 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5543 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5544 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5545 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5546 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5547 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5548 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5549 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5550 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5551 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5552 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005553 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5554 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005555
5556 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5557 and "fd@2", see above.
5558
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005559 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5560 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5561 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5562 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5563 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5564 having the logs instantly available.
5565
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005566 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5567 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005568
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005569 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5570 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5571 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5572 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5573 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5574 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5575 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5576 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5577 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5578 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005579 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005580
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005581 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5582 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5583 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5584 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5585 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5586
5587 <sample_size>
5588 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5589 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5590 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5591 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5592 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5593
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005594 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5595 one of the following :
5596
5597 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5598 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5599
5600 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5601 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5602
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005603 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5604 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5605 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5606 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5607 systemd logger consumes.
5608
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005609 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5610 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5611 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5612 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005614 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5615
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005616 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5617 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5618 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5619
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005620 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5621 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5622 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5623 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005624
5625 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5626 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5627 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005628 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5629 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5630 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5631 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5632 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005633
5634 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5635
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005636 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5637 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5638 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005639
5640 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5641 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5642 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5643 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5644
5645 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5646 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005647
5648 Example :
5649 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005650 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5651 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5652 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005653 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5654 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005655 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005656
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005657
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005658log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005659 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5661 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005662
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005663 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5664 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5665 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5666 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5667 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005668
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005669 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5670 "option httplog" directives.
5671
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005672log-format-sd <string>
5673 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5674 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5675 yes | yes | yes | no
5676
5677 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5678 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5679 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5680 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5681 which covers the log format string in depth.
5682
5683 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5684 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5685
5686 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5687 log format to "rfc5424".
5688
5689 Example :
5690 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5691
5692
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005693log-tag <string>
5694 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5695 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5696 yes | yes | yes | yes
5697
5698 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5699 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5700 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5701 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5702 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5703 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5704 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5705 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5706 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005707
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005708max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5709 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5711 yes | no | yes | yes
5712
5713 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5714 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5715 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5716 servers.
5717
5718 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5719 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5720 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5721 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5722 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005723 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005724 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5725 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5726 picking a different server.
5727
5728 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5729 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5730 even if they have to be queued.
5731
5732 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5733 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5734
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005735max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5736 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5737 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5738 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005739
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005740maxconn <conns>
5741 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | yes | yes | no
5744 Arguments :
5745 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5746 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5747 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5748 closes.
5749
5750 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5751 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5752 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5753 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005754 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5755 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5756 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5757 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005758
5759 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5760 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5761 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5762
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005763 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5764 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005766 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5767
5768
5769mode { tcp|http|health }
5770 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5772 yes | yes | yes | yes
5773 Arguments :
5774 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5775 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5776 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5777 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5778
5779 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5780 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5781 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5782 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5783 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5784
5785 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005786 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5787 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5788 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5789 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5790 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5791 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5792 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005793
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005794 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5795 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5796 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005797
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005798 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005799 defaults http_instances
5800 mode http
5801
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005802 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005804
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005805monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005806 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005809 Arguments :
5810 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5811 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005812 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005813 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5814 backend and its backup.
5815
5816 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5817 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5818 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5819 servers in a list of backends.
5820
5821 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5822 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5823 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5824 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5825 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5826 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5827 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005828 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5829 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005830
5831 Example:
5832 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005833 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005834 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5835 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5836 monitor-uri /site_alive
5837 monitor fail if site_dead
5838
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005839 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005840
5841
5842monitor-net <source>
5843 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5845 yes | yes | yes | no
5846 Arguments :
5847 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5848 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5849 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5850 followed by a mask.
5851
5852 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5853 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005854 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005855 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5856
5857 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5858 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5859 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5860 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005861 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5862 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5863 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005864
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005865 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5866 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5867 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5868 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5869 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5870 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005871
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005872 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5873 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005874
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005875 Example :
5876 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5877 frontend www
5878 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5879
5880 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5881
5882
5883monitor-uri <uri>
5884 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5886 yes | yes | yes | no
5887 Arguments :
5888 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5889 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5890
5891 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5892 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5893 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5894 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5895 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5896 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5897 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5898 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5899
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005900 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005901 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5902 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5903 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5904 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5905 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5906 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005907
5908 Example :
5909 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5910 frontend www
5911 mode http
5912 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5913
5914 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005916
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005917option abortonclose
5918no option abortonclose
5919 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5921 yes | no | yes | yes
5922 Arguments : none
5923
5924 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5925 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5926 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5927 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005928 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005929 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5930 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5931 encountered while delivering the response.
5932
5933 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5934 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5935 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5936 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5937 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5938 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005939 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005940 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005941 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005942 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5943 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5944 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5945
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005946 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5947 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005948 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5949 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5950 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5951 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5952 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5953 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005954 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005955
5956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5958
5959 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5960
5961
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005962option accept-invalid-http-request
5963no option accept-invalid-http-request
5964 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5966 yes | yes | yes | no
5967 Arguments : none
5968
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005969 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005970 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005971 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005972 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5973 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5974 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5975 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5976 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005977 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5978 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5979 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5980 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005981 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005982 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005983 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5984 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5985 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005986
5987 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5988 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5989 been confirmed.
5990
5991 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5992 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005993 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5994 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005995 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5996
5997 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5998 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5999
6000 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6001 stats socket.
6002
6003
6004option accept-invalid-http-response
6005no option accept-invalid-http-response
6006 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 yes | no | yes | yes
6009 Arguments : none
6010
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006011 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006012 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006013 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006014 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6015 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6016 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6017 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6018 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006019 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6020 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6021 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006022
6023 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6024 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6025 been confirmed.
6026
6027 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6028 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6029 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6030 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6031
6032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6034
6035 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6036 stats socket.
6037
6038
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006039option allbackups
6040no option allbackups
6041 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6043 yes | no | yes | yes
6044 Arguments : none
6045
6046 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6047 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6048 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6049 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6050 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6051 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6052 order between the backup servers anymore.
6053
6054 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6055 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6056
6057 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6058 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6059
6060
6061option checkcache
6062no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006063 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6065 yes | no | yes | yes
6066 Arguments : none
6067
6068 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6069 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006070 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006071 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6072 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006073 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006074
6075 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006076 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006077 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006078 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6079 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006080 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006081 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006082 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6083 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006084 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006085 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6086 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006087 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006088 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6089 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6090 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6091 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6092 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6093 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6094 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6095 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6096 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6097
6098 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006099 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6100 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6101 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6102 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006103
6104 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6105 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006106 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006107 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006108
6109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6111
6112
6113option clitcpka
6114no option clitcpka
6115 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6117 yes | yes | yes | no
6118 Arguments : none
6119
6120 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6121 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006122 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006123 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6124
6125 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6126 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6127 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6128 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6129
6130 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6131 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6132 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6133 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6134 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6135
6136 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6137
6138 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6139 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6140 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6141
6142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6144
6145 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6146
6147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006148option contstats
6149 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6151 yes | yes | yes | no
6152 Arguments : none
6153
6154 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6155 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6156 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6157 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006158 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6159 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6160 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6161 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6162 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006163
6164
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006165option dontlog-normal
6166no option dontlog-normal
6167 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6169 yes | yes | yes | no
6170 Arguments : none
6171
6172 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6173 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6174 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6175 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6176 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6177 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6178 logged.
6179
6180 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6181 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6182 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006184 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006185 logging.
6186
6187
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006188option dontlognull
6189no option dontlognull
6190 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6192 yes | yes | yes | no
6193 Arguments : none
6194
6195 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6196 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6197 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6198 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6199 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6200 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006201 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6202 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6203 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006204
6205 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006206 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006207 would not be logged.
6208
6209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6211
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006212 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6213 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006214
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006215
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006216option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006217 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6219 yes | yes | yes | yes
6220 Arguments :
6221 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6222 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006223 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006224 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006225
6226 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6227 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6228 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6229 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6230 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6231 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6232 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006233 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6234 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6235 possible that the client has already brought one.
6236
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006237 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006238 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006239 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006240 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006241 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006242 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006243
6244 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6245 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6246 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6247 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6248 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6249 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6250 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6251
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006252 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6253 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6254 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6255 are under the control of the end-user.
6256
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006257 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006258 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6259 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006260 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6261 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6262 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006263
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006264 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006265 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6266 frontend www
6267 mode http
6268 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6269
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006270 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6271 backend www
6272 mode http
6273 option forwardfor header X-Client
6274
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006275 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006276 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006277
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006278
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006279option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6280no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6281 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6283 yes | yes | yes | no
6284 Arguments : none
6285
6286 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6287 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6288 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6289 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6290 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6291 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6292 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6293
6294 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6295 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6296 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6297 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6298 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6299 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6300 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6301 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6302 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6303 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6304
6305 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6306
6307 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6308 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6309
6310 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6311 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6312
6313
6314option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6315no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6316 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6318 yes | no | yes | yes
6319 Arguments : none
6320
6321 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6322 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6323 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6324 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6325 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6326 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6327 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6328
6329 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6330 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6331 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6332 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6333 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6334 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6335 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6336 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6337 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6338 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6339
6340 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6341
6342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6344
6345 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6346 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6347
6348
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006349option http-buffer-request
6350no option http-buffer-request
6351 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6353 yes | yes | yes | yes
6354 Arguments : none
6355
6356 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6357 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6358 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6359 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6360 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6361 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006362 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6363 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6364 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6365 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006366
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006367 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006368
6369
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006370option http-ignore-probes
6371no option http-ignore-probes
6372 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6374 yes | yes | yes | no
6375 Arguments : none
6376
6377 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6378 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6379 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6380 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6381 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6382 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6383 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6384 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6385 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006386 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6387 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006388 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6389
6390 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6391 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6392 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6393 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6394 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6395 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6396 are often the only way to detect them.
6397
6398 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6399 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6400
6401 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6402
6403
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006404option http-keep-alive
6405no option http-keep-alive
6406 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6408 yes | yes | yes | yes
6409 Arguments : none
6410
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006411 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6412 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006413 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6414 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006415 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6416 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6417 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006418
6419 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6420 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006421 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6422 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6423 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6424 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6425 situations where this option may be useful :
6426
6427 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006428 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006429
6430 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6431 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6432
6433 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6434 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6435 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6436 request.
6437
6438 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6439 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006440 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6441 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6442 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006443
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006444 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6445 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6446 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6447 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6448 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6449 not set.
6450
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006451 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6452 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6453 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006454
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006455 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006456 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006457 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006458
6459
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006460option http-no-delay
6461no option http-no-delay
6462 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | yes | yes | yes
6465 Arguments : none
6466
6467 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6468 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6469 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6470 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6471 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6472 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6473 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6474 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6475 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6476 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6477 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6478 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6479 affected.
6480
6481 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6482 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6483 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6484 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6485 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6486 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6487 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6488 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6489 latency environments.
6490
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006491 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6492
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006493
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006494option http-pretend-keepalive
6495no option http-pretend-keepalive
6496 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006498 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006499 Arguments : none
6500
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006501 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006502 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6503 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6504 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6505 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6506 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6507 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6508 consider the response complete.
6509
6510 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6511 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6512 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6513 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006514 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006515 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6516
6517 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6518 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6519 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6520 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6521 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6522 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6523 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6524
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006525 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6526 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6527 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6528 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6529 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6530 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006531
6532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6534
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006535 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006536 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006537
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006538
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006539option http-server-close
6540no option http-server-close
6541 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6543 yes | yes | yes | yes
6544 Arguments : none
6545
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006546 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6547 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6548 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6549 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006550 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6551 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6552 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6553 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6554 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6555 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6556 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6557 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6558 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6559 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6560 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006561
6562 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6563 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6564 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6565 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006566 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6567 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006568
6569 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6570 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006571 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6572 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6573 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006574
6575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6577
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006578 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6579 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006580
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006581option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006582no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006583 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6585 yes | yes | yes | no
6586 Arguments : none
6587
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006588 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006589 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6590 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6591 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6592 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6593 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6594 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6595
6596 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6597 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006598 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6599 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6600 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006601
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006602 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6603 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6604 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6605 front of an existing proxy.
6606
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006607 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6608
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006609 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006610
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006611option httpchk
6612option httpchk <uri>
6613option httpchk <method> <uri>
6614option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6615 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6617 yes | no | yes | yes
6618 Arguments :
6619 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6620 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6621 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6622 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6623 ones.
6624
6625 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6626 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6627 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6628
6629 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6630 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6631 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6632 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6633 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6634
6635 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6636 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6637 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6638 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6639 the lack of any response.
6640
6641 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6642
6643 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6644 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6645 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6646
6647 Examples :
6648 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6649 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6650 backend https_relay
6651 mode tcp
6652 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6653 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6654
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006655 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6656 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6657 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006658
6659
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006660option httpclose
6661no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006662 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6664 yes | yes | yes | yes
6665 Arguments : none
6666
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006667 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6668 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6669 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6670 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006671 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006672
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006673 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6674 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006675 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006676 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6677 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006678
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006679 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6680 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6681 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006682
6683 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6684 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006685 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6686 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6687 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006688
6689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6691
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006692 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006693
6694
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006695option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006696 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006698 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006699 Arguments :
6700 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6701 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6702 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006703 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006704 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006705
6706 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6707 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6708 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6709 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6710 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6711 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6712 ports.
6713
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006714 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6715 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006716
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006717 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006719 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006720
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006721
6722option http_proxy
6723no option http_proxy
6724 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6726 yes | yes | yes | yes
6727 Arguments : none
6728
6729 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6730 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6731 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6732 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6733 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6734
6735 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6736 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006737 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6738 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006739
6740 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6741 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6742
6743 Example :
6744 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6745 backend direct_forward
6746 option httpclose
6747 option http_proxy
6748
6749 See also : "option httpclose"
6750
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006751
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006752option independent-streams
6753no option independent-streams
6754 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6756 yes | yes | yes | yes
6757 Arguments : none
6758
6759 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6760 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6761 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6762 receive data or not.
6763
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006764 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006765 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6766 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6767 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6768 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6769 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6770 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6771 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6772 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6773 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6774 socket buffers.
6775
6776 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6777 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6778 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6779 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6780 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6781
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006782 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006783
6784
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006785option ldap-check
6786 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6788 yes | no | yes | yes
6789 Arguments : none
6790
6791 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6792 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6793 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6794 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6795
6796 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6797 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6798
6799 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6800 configure it.
6801
6802 Example :
6803 option ldap-check
6804
6805 See also : "option httpchk"
6806
6807
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006808option external-check
6809 Use external processes for server health checks
6810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6811 yes | no | yes | yes
6812
6813 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6814 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6815 command".
6816
6817 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6818
6819 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6820
6821
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006822option log-health-checks
6823no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006824 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6826 yes | no | yes | yes
6827 Arguments : none
6828
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006829 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6830 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6831 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006832
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006833 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6834 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6835 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6836 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6837 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6838
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006839 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006840 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006841
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006842 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6843 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6844 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006845
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006846
6847option log-separate-errors
6848no option log-separate-errors
6849 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6851 yes | yes | yes | no
6852 Arguments : none
6853
6854 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6855 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6856 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6857 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6858 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6859 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6860 provides very important information.
6861
6862 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6863 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6864 error logs.
6865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006866 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006867 logging.
6868
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006869
6870option logasap
6871no option logasap
6872 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6874 yes | yes | yes | no
6875 Arguments : none
6876
6877 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6878 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6879 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6880 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6881 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6882 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6883 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006884 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006885 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6886 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6887
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006888 Examples :
6889 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6890 mode http
6891 option httplog
6892 option logasap
6893 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6894
6895 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6896 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6897 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6898 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006900 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006901 logging.
6902
6903
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006904option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006905 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6907 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006908 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006909 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6910 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006911 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006912
6913 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6914 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006915 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006916 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6917 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6918 in the MySQL table, like this :
6919
6920 USE mysql;
6921 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6922 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6923
6924 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006925 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006926 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6927 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6928 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6929 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6930 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6931 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6932 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6933
6934 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6935 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006936
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006937 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006938
6939 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6940 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6941 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6942 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006943 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6944 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006945
6946 See also: "option httpchk"
6947
6948
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006949option nolinger
6950no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006951 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006952 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6953 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006954 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006955
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006956 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006957 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6958 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6959 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6960 connections.
6961
6962 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6963 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6964 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6965 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6966 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6967 this too.
6968
6969 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6970 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6971 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6972
6973 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6974 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6975 for servers.
6976
6977 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6978 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6979
6980
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006981option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6982 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6984 yes | yes | yes | yes
6985 Arguments :
6986 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6987 matching <network>
6988 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6989 header name.
6990
6991 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6992 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6993 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6994 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6995 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6996 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6997 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6998 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6999 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7000 possible that the client has already brought one.
7001
7002 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7003 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7004 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7005 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7006 header and requires different one.
7007
7008 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7009 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7010 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7011 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7012 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7013 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7014 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7015
7016 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7017 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7018 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7019 both are defined.
7020
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007021 Examples :
7022 # Original Destination address
7023 frontend www
7024 mode http
7025 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7026
7027 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7028 backend www
7029 mode http
7030 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7031
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007032 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007033
7034
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007035option persist
7036no option persist
7037 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007040 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007041
7042 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7043 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7044 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7045 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7046 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7047 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7048 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7049 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7050 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7051 redirected to another valid server.
7052
7053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7055
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007056 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007057
7058
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007059option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7060 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7062 yes | no | yes | yes
7063 Arguments :
7064 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7065 PostgreSQL server.
7066
7067 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7068 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7069 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7070 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7071
7072 See also: "option httpchk"
7073
7074
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007075option prefer-last-server
7076no option prefer-last-server
7077 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7079 yes | no | yes | yes
7080 Arguments : none
7081
7082 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7083 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7084 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7085 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7086 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7087 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7088 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7089 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7090 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007091 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7092 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007093 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7094 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7095 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007096 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7097 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7098 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007099
7100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7102
7103 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7104
7105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007106option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007107option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007108no option redispatch
7109 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7111 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007112 Arguments :
7113 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7114 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7115 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007116 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007117 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007118 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007119 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7120 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7121 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007123
7124 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7125 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7126 be able to access the service anymore.
7127
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007128 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7129 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007130
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007131 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007132 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7133 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7137
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007138 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007139
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007140
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007141option redis-check
7142 Use redis health checks for server testing
7143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7144 yes | no | yes | yes
7145 Arguments : none
7146
7147 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7148 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7149 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7150 find the "+PONG" response message.
7151
7152 Example :
7153 option redis-check
7154
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007155 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007156
7157
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007158option smtpchk
7159option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7160 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7162 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007163 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007164 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007165 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007166 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7167
7168 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7169 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7170 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7171
7172 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7173 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7174 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7175 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7176 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7177 dead server.
7178
7179 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7180 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007181 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007182 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7183
7184 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7185 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7186 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7187 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007188 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007189
7190 Example :
7191 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7192
7193 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007196option socket-stats
7197no option socket-stats
7198
7199 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7201 yes | yes | yes | no
7202
7203 Arguments : none
7204
7205
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007206option splice-auto
7207no option splice-auto
7208 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7210 yes | yes | yes | yes
7211 Arguments : none
7212
7213 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7214 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007215 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007216 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007217 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007218 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7219 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7220 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7221 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7222
7223 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7224 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7225 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7226 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7227 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7228 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7229 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7230 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7231 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7232 keyword.
7233
7234 Example :
7235 option splice-auto
7236
7237 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7238 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7239
7240 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7241 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7242
7243
7244option splice-request
7245no option splice-request
7246 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7248 yes | yes | yes | yes
7249 Arguments : none
7250
7251 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007252 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007253 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7254 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7255 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7256 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7257
7258 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7259
7260 Example :
7261 option splice-request
7262
7263 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7264 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7265
7266 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7267 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7268
7269
7270option splice-response
7271no option splice-response
7272 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7274 yes | yes | yes | yes
7275 Arguments : none
7276
7277 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007278 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007279 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7280 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7281 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7282 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7283
7284 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7285
7286 Example :
7287 option splice-response
7288
7289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7291
7292 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7293 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7294
7295
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007296option spop-check
7297 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 no | no | no | yes
7300 Arguments : none
7301
7302 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7303 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7304 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7305 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7306
7307 Example :
7308 option spop-check
7309
7310 See also : "option httpchk"
7311
7312
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007313option srvtcpka
7314no option srvtcpka
7315 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7317 yes | no | yes | yes
7318 Arguments : none
7319
7320 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7321 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007322 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007323 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7324
7325 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7326 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7327 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7328 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7329
7330 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7331 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7332 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7333 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7334 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7335
7336 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7337
7338 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7339 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7340 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7341
7342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7344
7345 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7346
7347
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007348option ssl-hello-chk
7349 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7351 yes | no | yes | yes
7352 Arguments : none
7353
7354 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7355 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7356 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7357 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7358 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7359 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7360 hello message.
7361
7362 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7363 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7364 messages, which is appreciable.
7365
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007366 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7367 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7368 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007369
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007370 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7371
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007372
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007373option tcp-check
7374 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7376 yes | no | yes | yes
7377
7378 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7379 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7380
7381 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7382 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7383 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7384
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007385 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007386 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7387 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7388 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7389 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7390 only.
7391
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007392 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007393 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7394 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7395 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7396 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7397
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007398 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007399 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7400 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007401 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007402 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7403 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7404 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7405 the respective protocols.
7406 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007407 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007408
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007409 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7410 script.
7411
7412 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7413 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7414 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7415 The "comment" is of course optional.
7416
7417
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007418 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007419 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007420 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007421 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007422
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007423 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007424 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007425 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007426
7427 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7428 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007429 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007430 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007431 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007432 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007433 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007434 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007435 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7436 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007437 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007438 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7439 tcp-check expect string +OK
7440
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007441 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007442 (send many headers before analyzing)
7443 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007444 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007445 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7446 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7447 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7448 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007449 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007450
7451
7452 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7453
7454
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007455option tcp-smart-accept
7456no option tcp-smart-accept
7457 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7459 yes | yes | yes | no
7460 Arguments : none
7461
7462 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7463 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7464 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7465 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7466 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7467 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7468
7469 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7470 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7471 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7472 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7473
7474 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7475 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7476 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007477 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007478
7479 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7480 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7481 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7482
7483 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7484 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7485 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7486
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007487 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7488
7489
7490option tcp-smart-connect
7491no option tcp-smart-connect
7492 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7494 yes | no | yes | yes
7495 Arguments : none
7496
7497 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7498 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7499 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7500 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7501 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7502
7503 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7504 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7505 complex.
7506
7507 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7508 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7509 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7510
7511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7513
7514 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7515
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007516
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007517option tcpka
7518 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7520 yes | yes | yes | yes
7521 Arguments : none
7522
7523 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7524 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007525 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007526 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7527
7528 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7529 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7530 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7531 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7532
7533 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7534 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7535 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7536 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7537 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7538
7539 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7540
7541 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7542 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7543 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7544 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7545 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7546 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7547 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7548 backends.
7549
7550 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7551
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007552
7553option tcplog
7554 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007556 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007557 Arguments : none
7558
7559 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7560 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7561 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7562 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7563 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7564 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7565 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7566 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7567
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007568 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007570 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007571
7572
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007573option transparent
7574no option transparent
7575 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007577 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007578 Arguments : none
7579
7580 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7581 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7582 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7583 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7584 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7585 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7586 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7587 appropriate server.
7588
7589 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7590 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7591
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007592 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007593 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007594
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007595
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007596external-check command <command>
7597 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 yes | no | yes | yes
7600
7601 Arguments :
7602 <command> is the external command to run
7603
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007604 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7605
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007606 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007607
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007608 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7609 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7610 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7611 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7612 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7613 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007614
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007615 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7616
7617 Environment variables :
7618 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7619 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7620
7621 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7622
7623 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7624
7625 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7626 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7627 for a UNIX socket).
7628
7629 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7630
7631 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7632
7633 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7634
7635 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7636
7637 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7638
7639 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7640 socket).
7641
7642 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7643 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7644
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007645 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7646
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007647 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7648 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7649 failed.
7650
7651 Example :
7652 external-check command /bin/true
7653
7654 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7655
7656
7657external-check path <path>
7658 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7660 yes | no | yes | yes
7661
7662 Arguments :
7663 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7664
7665 The default path is "".
7666
7667 Example :
7668 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7669
7670 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7671 "external-check command"
7672
7673
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007674persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007675persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007676 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7678 yes | no | yes | yes
7679 Arguments :
7680 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007681 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7682 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007683
7684 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7685 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007686 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007687 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7688 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7689 forwarded to this server.
7690
7691 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7692 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7693 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007694 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007695 a single "listen" section.
7696
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007697 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7698 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7699 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7700
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007701 Example :
7702 listen tse-farm
7703 bind :3389
7704 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7705 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7706 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7707 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7708 persist rdp-cookie
7709 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007710 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007711 balance rdp-cookie
7712 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7713 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7714
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007715 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7716 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007717
7718
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007719rate-limit sessions <rate>
7720 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7722 yes | yes | yes | no
7723 Arguments :
7724 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7725 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7726
7727 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7728 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7729 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7730 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7731 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7732 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7733
7734 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7735 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7736 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7737 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7738
7739 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7740 listen smtp
7741 mode tcp
7742 bind :25
7743 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007744 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007745
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007746 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7747 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7748 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007749
7750 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7751
7752
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007753redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7754redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7755redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007756 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7758 no | yes | yes | yes
7759
7760 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007761 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007762
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007763 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007764 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007765 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7766 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7767 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007768
7769 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7770 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7771 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7772 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7773 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007774 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7775 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7776 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7777 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007778
7779 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7780 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7781 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7782 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7783 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7784 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007785 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007786 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007787 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7788 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7789 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007790
7791 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007792 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7793 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7794 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007795 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007796 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7797 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7798 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7799 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007800
7801 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007802 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007803
7804 - "drop-query"
7805 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7806 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7807 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7808 with a location-type redirect.
7809
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007810 - "append-slash"
7811 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7812 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7813 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7814 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7815
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007816 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7817 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7818 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7819 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7820 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7821 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7822 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7823
7824 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7825 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7826 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7827 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7828 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7829 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7830 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007831
7832 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7833 acl clear dst_port 80
7834 acl secure dst_port 8080
7835 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007836 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007837 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007838 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7839
7840 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007841 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7842 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7843 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007844 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007845
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007846 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7847 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7848 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7849
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007850 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007851 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007852
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007853 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007854 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7855 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7856 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007858 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007859
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007860
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007861retries <value>
7862 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7864 yes | no | yes | yes
7865 Arguments :
7866 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7867 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7868 default value is 3.
7869
7870 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7871 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7872 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7873
7874 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007875 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7876 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007877
7878 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7879 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7880
7881 See also : "option redispatch"
7882
7883
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007884retry-on [list of keywords]
7885 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7887 yes | no | yes | yes
7888 Arguments :
7889 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7890 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7891 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7892 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7893
7894 none never retry
7895
7896 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7897 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7898
7899 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7900 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7901 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7902 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7903 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7904 processing the request.
7905
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007906 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7907 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7908 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7909 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7910 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7911 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7912 overflow attack for example).
7913
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007914 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7915 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7916 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7917 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7918 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7919 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7920 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7921 amplify denial of service attacks.
7922
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007923 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7924 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7925 considered to be safe to retry.
7926
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007927 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7928 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7929 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7930 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7931
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007932 all-retryable-errors
7933 retry request for any error that are considered
7934 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7935 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7936 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7937
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007938 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7939 not cumulative.
7940
7941 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7942 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7943 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7944 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7945
7946 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7947 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7948 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7949 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7950 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7951 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7952 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7953 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7954 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7955 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7956 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7957 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7958
7959 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7960 should not use this directive.
7961
7962 The default is "conn-failure".
7963
7964 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7965
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007966server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007967 Declare a server in a backend
7968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7969 no | no | yes | yes
7970 Arguments :
7971 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007972 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007973 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007974
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007975 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7976 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7977 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7978 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007979 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7980 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7981 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7982 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7983 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007984 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7985 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7986 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7987 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7988 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7989 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7990 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007991 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007992 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7993 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7994 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7995 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7996 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7997 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007998 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7999 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008000 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8001 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008002
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008003 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008004 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8005 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8006 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8007 adding this value to the client's port.
8008
8009 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8010 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008011 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008012
8013 Examples :
8014 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8015 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008016 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008017 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8018 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8019 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008020
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008021 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8022 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8023 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8024 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8025 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8026
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008027 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8028 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008029
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008030server-state-file-name [<file>]
8031 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8032 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8033 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8034 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8035 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8036 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8037
8038 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8039 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8040
8041 global
8042 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8043
8044 backend bk
8045 load-server-state-from-file
8046
8047 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8048 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008049
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008050server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8051 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8052 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8054 no | no | yes | yes
8055
8056 Arguments:
8057 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8058
8059 <num | range>
8060 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8061 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8062 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8063 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8064
8065 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8066
8067 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8068
8069 <params*>
8070 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8071 keyword.
8072
8073 Examples:
8074 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8075 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8076 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8077
8078 # or
8079 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8080
8081 # would be equivalent to:
8082 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8083 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8084 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8085
8086
8087
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008088source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008089source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008090source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008091 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8093 yes | no | yes | yes
8094 Arguments :
8095 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8096 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008097
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008098 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008099 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8100 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8101 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8102 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8103 supported prefixes are :
8104 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8105 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8106 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008107 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008108 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8109 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008110
8111 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8112 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008113 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8114 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8115 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008116
8117 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8118 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8119 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8120 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8121 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8122 <addr>.
8123
8124 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8125 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8126 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8127 port.
8128
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008129 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8130 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8131 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8132 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008133 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008134 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8135 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8136 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8137 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8138 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8139 HTTP header.
8140
8141 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8142 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008143 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008144 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8145 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8146 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8147 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8148 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8149 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8150 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8151
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008152 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8153 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8154 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8155 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8156 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8157 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8158
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008159 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8160 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8161 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8162 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8163
8164 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8165 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8166 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8167 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8168 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8169 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8170
8171 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8172 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8173 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8174 there are two methods :
8175
8176 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8177 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8178 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8179 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8180 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8181 of the client ranges may be used.
8182
8183 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8184 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8185 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8186 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8187 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8188 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8189 same session.
8190
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008191 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8192 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8193 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008194 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008195
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008196 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8197
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008198 Examples :
8199 backend private
8200 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8201 source 192.168.1.200
8202
8203 backend transparent_ssl1
8204 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8205 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8206
8207 backend transparent_ssl2
8208 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8209 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8210 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8211
8212 backend transparent_ssl3
8213 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8214 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8215 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8216
8217 backend transparent_smtp
8218 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8219 # with Tproxy version 4.
8220 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8221
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008222 backend transparent_http
8223 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8224 # proxy.
8225 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008227 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008228 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8229
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008230
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008231stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8232 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008234 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008235
8236 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8237 matched.
8238
8239 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8240 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8241
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008242 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8243 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008244 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008245
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008246 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8247 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8248 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8249 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008250
8251 Example :
8252 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8253 backend stats_localhost
8254 stats enable
8255 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8256
8257 Example :
8258 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8259 backend stats_auth
8260 stats enable
8261 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8262 stats admin if TRUE
8263
8264 Example :
8265 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8266 userlist stats-auth
8267 group admin users admin
8268 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8269 group readonly users haproxy
8270 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8271
8272 backend stats_auth
8273 stats enable
8274 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8275 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8276 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8277 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8278
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008279 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8280 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8281 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008282
8283
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008284stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8285 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008287 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008288 Arguments :
8289 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8290
8291 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8292
8293 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8294 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8295 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8296 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8297 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8298 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8299
8300 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8301 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8302 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008303 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008304
8305 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8306 report using "stats scope".
8307
8308 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8309 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8310 unobvious parameters.
8311
8312 Example :
8313 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8314 backend public_www
8315 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8316 stats enable
8317 stats hide-version
8318 stats scope .
8319 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008320 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008321 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8322 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8323
8324 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8325 backend private_monitoring
8326 stats enable
8327 stats uri /admin?stats
8328 stats refresh 5s
8329
8330 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8331
8332
8333stats enable
8334 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008336 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008337 Arguments : none
8338
8339 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8340 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8341 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8342 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8343 - stats auth : no authentication
8344 - stats scope : no restriction
8345
8346 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8347 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8348 unobvious parameters.
8349
8350 Example :
8351 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8352 backend public_www
8353 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8354 stats enable
8355 stats hide-version
8356 stats scope .
8357 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008358 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008359 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8360 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8361
8362 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8363 backend private_monitoring
8364 stats enable
8365 stats uri /admin?stats
8366 stats refresh 5s
8367
8368 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8369
8370
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008371stats hide-version
8372 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008374 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008375 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008376
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008377 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8378 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8379 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8380 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8381 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8382 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008384 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8385 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8386 unobvious parameters.
8387
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008388 Example :
8389 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8390 backend public_www
8391 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008392 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008393 stats hide-version
8394 stats scope .
8395 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008396 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008397 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8398 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008399
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008400 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8401 backend private_monitoring
8402 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008403 stats uri /admin?stats
8404 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008405
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008406 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008407
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008408
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008409stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8410 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8411 Access control for statistics
8412
8413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8414 no | no | yes | yes
8415
8416 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8417 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8418 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8419 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8420 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8421 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8422
8423 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8424 instance.
8425
8426 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8427 about ACL usage.
8428
8429
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008430stats realm <realm>
8431 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008433 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008434 Arguments :
8435 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8436 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8437 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8438
8439 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8440 using a backslash ('\').
8441
8442 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8443 only related to authentication.
8444
8445 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8446 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8447 unobvious parameters.
8448
8449 Example :
8450 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8451 backend public_www
8452 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8453 stats enable
8454 stats hide-version
8455 stats scope .
8456 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008457 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008458 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8459 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8460
8461 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8462 backend private_monitoring
8463 stats enable
8464 stats uri /admin?stats
8465 stats refresh 5s
8466
8467 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8468
8469
8470stats refresh <delay>
8471 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008473 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008474 Arguments :
8475 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8476 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8477 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8478 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8479 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8480 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8481
8482 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8483 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8484 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8485 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8486
8487 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8488 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8489 unobvious parameters.
8490
8491 Example :
8492 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8493 backend public_www
8494 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8495 stats enable
8496 stats hide-version
8497 stats scope .
8498 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008499 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008500 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8501 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8502
8503 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8504 backend private_monitoring
8505 stats enable
8506 stats uri /admin?stats
8507 stats refresh 5s
8508
8509 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8510
8511
8512stats scope { <name> | "." }
8513 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008515 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008516 Arguments :
8517 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8518 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8519 section in which the statement appears.
8520
8521 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8522 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8523 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8524 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8525 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8526 exists.
8527
8528 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8529 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8530 unobvious parameters.
8531
8532 Example :
8533 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8534 backend public_www
8535 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8536 stats enable
8537 stats hide-version
8538 stats scope .
8539 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008540 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008541 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8542 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8543
8544 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8545 backend private_monitoring
8546 stats enable
8547 stats uri /admin?stats
8548 stats refresh 5s
8549
8550 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8551
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008552
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008553stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008554 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008556 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008557
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008558 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008559 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8560
8561 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8562 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8563
8564 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8565 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008566 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008567
8568 Example :
8569 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8570 backend private_monitoring
8571 stats enable
8572 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8573 stats uri /admin?stats
8574 stats refresh 5s
8575
8576 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8577 global section.
8578
8579
8580stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008581 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8583 yes | yes | yes | yes
8584 Arguments : none
8585
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008586 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008587 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8588 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8589 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8590 - IP (socket, server)
8591 - cookie (backend, server)
8592
8593 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8594 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008595 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008596
8597 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8598
8599
8600stats show-node [ <name> ]
8601 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008603 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008604 Arguments:
8605 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8606 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8607
8608 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8609 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008610 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008611
8612 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8613 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8614 unobvious parameters.
8615
8616 Example:
8617 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8618 backend private_monitoring
8619 stats enable
8620 stats show-node Europe-1
8621 stats uri /admin?stats
8622 stats refresh 5s
8623
8624 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8625 section.
8626
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008627
8628stats uri <prefix>
8629 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008631 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008632 Arguments :
8633 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8634 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8635 query string.
8636
8637 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8638 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8639 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8640 possible to reach it in the application.
8641
8642 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008643 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008644 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8645 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8646 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8647 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8648
8649 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8650 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8651 an address or a port to statistics only.
8652
8653 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8654 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8655 unobvious parameters.
8656
8657 Example :
8658 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8659 backend public_www
8660 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8661 stats enable
8662 stats hide-version
8663 stats scope .
8664 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008665 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008666 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8667 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8668
8669 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8670 backend private_monitoring
8671 stats enable
8672 stats uri /admin?stats
8673 stats refresh 5s
8674
8675 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8676
8677
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008678stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8679 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008681 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008682
8683 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008684 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008685 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008686 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008687 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8688
8689 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8690 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8691 the "stick-table" statement.
8692
8693 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8694 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8695 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8696 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8697 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8698
8699 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8700 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8701 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8702 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8703 transformation rules.
8704
8705 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8706 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8707 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8708 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8709 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8710 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8711 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8712
8713 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8714 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8715 ACL based conditions.
8716
8717 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8718 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8719 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8720 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8721
8722 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8723 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8724 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8725 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8726
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008727 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8728 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008729 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008730
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008731 Example :
8732 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8733 # last 30 minutes
8734 backend pop
8735 mode tcp
8736 balance roundrobin
8737 stick store-request src
8738 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8739 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8740 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8741
8742 backend smtp
8743 mode tcp
8744 balance roundrobin
8745 stick match src table pop
8746 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8747 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8748
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008749 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008750 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008751
8752
8753stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8754 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8756 no | no | yes | yes
8757
8758 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8759 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8760 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8761 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8762
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008763 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8764 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008765 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008766
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008767 Examples :
8768 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008769 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008770
8771 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8772 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8773 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8774
8775
8776 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8777 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8778 backend http
8779 mode http
8780 balance roundrobin
8781 stick on src table https
8782 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8783 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8784 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8785
8786 backend https
8787 mode tcp
8788 balance roundrobin
8789 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8790 stick on src
8791 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8792 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8793
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008794 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008795
8796
8797stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8798 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8800 no | no | yes | yes
8801
8802 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008803 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008804 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008805 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008806 server is selected.
8807
8808 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8809 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8810 the "stick-table" statement.
8811
8812 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8813 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8814 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8815 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8816 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8817 address.
8818
8819 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8820 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8821 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8822 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8823 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8824 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8825 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8826 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8827 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8828 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8829
8830 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8831 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8832 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8833 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8834 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8835 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8836 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8837
8838 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8839 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8840 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8841 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8842
8843 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8844 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8845 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8846 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8847 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8848 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008849 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8850 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8851 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8852 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8853 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8854 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008855
8856 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8857 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8858 the request.
8859
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008860 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8861 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008862 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008863
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008864 Example :
8865 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8866 # last 30 minutes
8867 backend pop
8868 mode tcp
8869 balance roundrobin
8870 stick store-request src
8871 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8872 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8873 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8874
8875 backend smtp
8876 mode tcp
8877 balance roundrobin
8878 stick match src table pop
8879 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8880 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8881
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008882 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008883 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008884
8885
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008886stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008887 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8888 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008889 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008891 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008892
8893 Arguments :
8894 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8895 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8896 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8897 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8898
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008899 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8900 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8901 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8902 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8903
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008904 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8905 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8906 instance.
8907
8908 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8909 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8910 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8911 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8912 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8913 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008914 to 32 characters.
8915
8916 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8917 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8918 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008919 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008920 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8921 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008922
8923 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008924 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8925 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008926 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8927 increase.
8928
8929 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008930 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8931 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8932 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008933
8934 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8935 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8936 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8937 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008938 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008939 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8940 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8941 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8942 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8943 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8944 parameter (see below).
8945
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008946 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8947 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8948 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8949 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8950 soft restart.
8951
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008952 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8953 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008954
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008955 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8956 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8957 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8958 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008959 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008960 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008961 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8962 if not expiration delay is specified.
8963
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008964 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8965 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8966 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8967 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008968 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8969 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8970 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8971 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8972 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8973 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8974 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8975 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8976 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8977 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8978 types and their arguments.
8979
8980 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8981 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8982 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8983 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8984
8985 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8986 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8987 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008988 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008989
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008990 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8991 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8992 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008993 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008994 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008995 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008996
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008997 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8998 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8999 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9000 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9001
9002 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9003 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9004 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9005 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9006 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9007 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9008
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009009 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9010 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9011 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9012 they were received.
9013
9014 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9015 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9016 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9017 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9018 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9019
9020 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9021 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9022 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9023 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9024 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9025
9026 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9027 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9028 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9029
9030 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9031 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9032 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9033 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9034 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9035
9036 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9037 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9038 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9039 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9040 the client side.
9041
9042 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9043 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9044 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9045 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9046 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9047 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9048 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9049
9050 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9051 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9052 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9053 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9054 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9055 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009056 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009057
9058 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9059 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9060 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9061 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9062 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9063 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9064
9065 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009066 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009067 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9068 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9069
9070 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9071 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9072 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9073 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9074 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9075 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9076 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9077 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9078 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9079 recommended for better fairness.
9080
9081 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009082 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009083 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9084 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9085
9086 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9087 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9088 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9089 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9090 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9091 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9092 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9093 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9094 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9095 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009096
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009097 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9098 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009099 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9100 reference it.
9101
9102 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9103 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009104 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9105 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9106 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009107
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009108 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9109 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9110 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9111 something that can be ignored.
9112
9113 Example:
9114 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9115 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9116 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9117 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9118
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009119 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009120 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009121
9122
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009123stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009124 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9126 no | no | yes | yes
9127
9128 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009129 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009130 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009131 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009132 server is selected.
9133
9134 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9135 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9136 the "stick-table" statement.
9137
9138 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9139 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9140 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9141 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9142
9143 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9144 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9145 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9146 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9147 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9148 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009149 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009150 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9151 rules.
9152
9153 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9154 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9155 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9156 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9157 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9158 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9159 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9160
9161 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9162 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9163 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9164 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9165
9166 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9167 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9168 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9169 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9170 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9171 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009172 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9173 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9174 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9175 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9176 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9177 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9178 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9179 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9180 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009181
9182 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9183
9184 Example :
9185 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9186 backend https
9187 mode tcp
9188 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009189 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009190 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009191
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009192 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9193 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9194
9195 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9196 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9197 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9198
9199 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9200 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009201
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009202 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9203 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9204 # at offset 44.
9205
9206 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9207 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9208
9209 # Learn on response if server hello.
9210 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009211
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009212 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9213 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9214
9215 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9216 extraction.
9217
9218
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009219tcp-check connect [params*]
9220 Opens a new connection
9221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9222 no | no | yes | yes
9223
9224 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9225 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9226 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9227
9228 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9229 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9230 of the sequence.
9231
9232 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9233 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9234 do.
9235
9236 Parameters :
9237 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9238 use the TCP connection.
9239
9240 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9241 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9242 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9243
9244 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9245
9246 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9247
9248 Examples:
9249 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9250 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9251 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9252 option tcp-check
9253 tcp-check connect
9254 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9255 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9256 tcp-check send \r\n
9257 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9258 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9259 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9260 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9261 tcp-check send \r\n
9262 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9263 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9264
9265 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9266 option tcp-check
9267 tcp-check connect port 110
9268 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9269 tcp-check connect port 143
9270 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9271 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9272
9273 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9274
9275
9276tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009277 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009278 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9279 no | no | yes | yes
9280
9281 Arguments :
9282 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9283 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9284 binary.
9285 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9286 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9287 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9288
9289 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9290 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9291 with the usual backslash ('\').
9292 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009293 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009294 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9295 used upper or lower case.
9296
9297
9298 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9299
9300 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9301 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9302 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9303 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9304 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9305 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9306 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9307 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9308
9309 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9310 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9311 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9312 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9313 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9314 expression.
9315
9316 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9317 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9318 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9319 this exact hexadecimal string.
9320 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9321
9322 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9323 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9324 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9325 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9326 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9327 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9328 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9329 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9330 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9331 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9332 the null character.
9333
9334 Examples :
9335 # perform a POP check
9336 option tcp-check
9337 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9338
9339 # perform an IMAP check
9340 option tcp-check
9341 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9342
9343 # look for the redis master server
9344 option tcp-check
9345 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009346 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009347 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9348 tcp-check expect string role:master
9349 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9350 tcp-check expect string +OK
9351
9352
9353 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9354 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9355
9356
9357tcp-check send <data>
9358 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9360 no | no | yes | yes
9361
9362 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9363 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9364
9365 Examples :
9366 # look for the redis master server
9367 option tcp-check
9368 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9369 tcp-check expect string role:master
9370
9371 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9372 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9373
9374
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009375tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9376 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009377 tcp health check
9378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9379 no | no | yes | yes
9380
9381 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9382 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009383 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009384 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9385 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9386 hexadecimal string.
9387 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9388
9389 Examples :
9390 # redis check in binary
9391 option tcp-check
9392 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9393 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9394
9395
9396 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9397 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9398
9399
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009400tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9401 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9403 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009404 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009405 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9406 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009407
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009408 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009409
9410 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9411 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009412 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9413 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9414 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9415 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9416 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9417 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009418
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009419 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9420 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9421 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9422 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009423
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009424 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009425 - accept :
9426 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9427 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9428 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009429
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009430 - reject :
9431 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9432 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9433 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9434 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9435 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9436 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9437 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9438 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9439 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9440 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9441 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009442 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009443
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009444 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9445 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9446 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9447 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9448 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9449 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9450 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9451 hosts.
9452
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009453 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9454 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9455 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9456 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9457 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9458 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9459 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9460 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9461
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009462 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9463 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9464 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9465 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9466 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9467 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9468 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9469 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9470 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009471 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9472 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009473
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009474 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009475 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009476 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9477 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9478 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009479 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009480 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9481 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9482 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9483 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9484 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9485 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9486 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9487 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009488
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009489 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009490 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009491 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009492 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009493 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9494 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9495 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009496
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009497 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9498 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9499 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9500 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009502 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9503 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9504 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9505 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9506 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009507 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9508 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9509 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9510 layer7 information is extracted.
9511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009512 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9513 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9514 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9515 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9516 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009517
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009518 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9519 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9520 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9521 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9522
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009523 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9524 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9525 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9526 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9527
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009528 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9529 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9530 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9531 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9532 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009533
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009534 - set-src <expr> :
9535 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9536 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9537 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009538 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009539
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009540 Arguments:
9541 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9542 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009543
9544 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009545 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9546
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009547 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9548 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009549
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009550 - set-src-port <expr> :
9551 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9552 expression.
9553
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009554 Arguments:
9555 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9556 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009557
9558 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009559 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9560
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009561 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9562 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9563 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009564
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009565 - set-dst <expr> :
9566 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9567 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9568 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9569 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9570 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9571
9572 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9573 followed by some converters.
9574
9575 Example:
9576
9577 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9578 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9579
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009580 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9581 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9582
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009583 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9584 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9585 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9586 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9587
9588
9589 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9590 followed by some converters.
9591
9592 Example:
9593
9594 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9595
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009596 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9597 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9598 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9599
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009600 - "silent-drop" :
9601 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009602 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009603 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9604 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9605 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9606 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9607 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009608 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9609 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009610 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9611 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009612 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009613 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9614 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9615 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9616 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9617
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009618 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9619 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9620 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009622 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9623 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9624 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009625
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009626 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009627 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009628 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009629
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009630 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9631 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9632 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009633
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009634 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009635 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9636 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009637
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009638 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9639
9640 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9641
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009642 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9643
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009644 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009645
9646
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009647tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9648 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009650 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009651 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009652 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9653 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009654
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009655 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009656
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009657 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009658 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9659 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9660 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9661 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009662
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009663 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9664 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9665 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9666 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009667 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9668 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9669 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9670 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9671 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9672 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009673 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009674 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009675
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009676 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9677 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9678 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9679 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009680
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009681 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009682 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009683 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009684 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9685 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009686 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009687 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009688 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009689 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009690 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009691 - set-dst <expr>
9692 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009693 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009694 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009695 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009696 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009697 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009699 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9700 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009701 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9702 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009703
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009704 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9705 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9706 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9707 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9708 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9709 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009711 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009712 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9713 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009714
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009715 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009716 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9717 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9718 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9719 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009720 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9721 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9722 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009723
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009724 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009725 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9726 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9727 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009728
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009729 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9730 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9731
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009732 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009733 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9734 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009735
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009736 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9737 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009738 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009739 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9740 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009741 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009742 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009743 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009744 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9745 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009746 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009747 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9748 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009749
9750 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9751 followed by some converters.
9752
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009753 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9754 <var-name>.
9755
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009756 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9757 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9758 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9759 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9760 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9761
9762 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9763 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9764 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9765 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9766 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9767 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9768 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9769 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9770 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9771 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9772 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9773
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009774 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9775 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9776 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9777 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9778 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9779
9780 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9781
9782 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9783
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009784 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9785 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9786 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9787 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9788 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9789 evaluated.
9790
9791 Example:
9792 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9793
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009794 Example:
9795
9796 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009797 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009798
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009799 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009800 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9801 # and reject everything else.
9802 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9803 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009804 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009805 tcp-request content reject
9806
9807 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009808 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9809 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9810 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009811 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009812
9813 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9814 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9815 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009816 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009817 tcp-request content reject
9818
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009819 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009820 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009821 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009822 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009823 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9824 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009825
9826 Example:
9827 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9828 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009829 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009830
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009831 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009832 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009833
9834 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009835 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009836 # protecting all our sites
9837 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009838 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9839 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009840 ...
9841 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9842
9843 backend http_dynamic
9844 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009845 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009846 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009847 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009848 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009849 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009850 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009852 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009853
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009854 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9855 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009856
9857
9858tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9859 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009861 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009862 Arguments :
9863 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9864 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9865 as explained at the top of this document.
9866
9867 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9868 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9869 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9870 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9871 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9872
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009873 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9874 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9875 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9876 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9877
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009878 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9879 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009880 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009881 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009882 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9883 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9884 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9885 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009886
9887 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9888 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9889 it pass through unaffected.
9890
9891 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9892 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9893 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009894 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009895 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9896 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009897 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9898 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9899 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009900
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009901 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009902 "timeout client".
9903
9904
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009905tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9906 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9908 no | no | yes | yes
9909 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009910 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9911 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009912
9913 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9914
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009915 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009916 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9917 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009918 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9919 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009920
9921 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9922
9923 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9924 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9925 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9926 inserted.
9927
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009928 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009929 - accept :
9930 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9931 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9932 the rules evaluation.
9933
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009934 - close :
9935 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9936 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9937 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9938 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9939 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9940 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009941 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009942 protocols.
9943
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009944 - reject :
9945 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9946 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009947 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009948
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009949 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9950 Sets a variable.
9951
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009952 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9953 Unsets a variable.
9954
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009955 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9956 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9957 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9958 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9959
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009960 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9961 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9962 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9963 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9964
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009965 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
9966 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9967 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9968 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9969 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009970
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009971 - "silent-drop" :
9972 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009973 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009974 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9975 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9976 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9977 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9978 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009979 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9980 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009981 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9982 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009983 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009984 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9985 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9986 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9987 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9988
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009989 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9990 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9991
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009992 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9993 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9994 for changing the default action to a reject.
9995
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009996 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9997 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9998 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9999 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010000 period.
10001
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010002 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10003 declared inline.
10004
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010005 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10006 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10009 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010010 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010011 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010012 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010013 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10014 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010015 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010016 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10017 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010018
10019 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10020 followed by some converters.
10021
10022 Example:
10023
10024 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10025
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010026 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10027 <var-name>.
10028
10029 Example:
10030
10031 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10032
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010033 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10034 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10035 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10036 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10037 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10038
10039 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10040
10041 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10042
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010043 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10044
10045 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10046
10047
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010048tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10049 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10051 no | yes | yes | no
10052 Arguments :
10053 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10054 below.
10055
10056 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10057
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010058 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010059 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10060 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10061 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10062 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10063 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10064 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10065 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010066 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010067 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10068 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10069 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10070 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10071 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10072 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10073 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10074 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10075 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10076 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10077 instead.
10078
10079 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10080 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10081 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10082 rules which may be inserted.
10083
10084 Several types of actions are supported :
10085 - accept : the request is accepted
10086 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10087 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10088 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010089 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010090 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010091 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010092 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010093 - silent-drop
10094
10095 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10096 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10097 sections for a complete description.
10098
10099 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10100 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10101 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10102
10103 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10104 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10105 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10106 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10107 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10108
10109 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10110 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10111
10112 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10113 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10114 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10115
10116 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10117 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10118 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10119
10120 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10121 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10122 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10123
10124 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10125 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10126 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10127
10128 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10129
10130 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10131
10132
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010133tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10134 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10136 no | no | yes | yes
10137 Arguments :
10138 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10139 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10140 as explained at the top of this document.
10141
10142 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10143
10144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010145timeout check <timeout>
10146 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10147 established.
10148
10149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10150 yes | no | yes | yes
10151 Arguments:
10152 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10153 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10154 as explained at the top of this document.
10155
10156 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10157 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010158 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010159 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010160 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10161 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10162 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010163
10164 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10165 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10166
10167 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10168 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010169 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010170
10171 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10172 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10173 forget about it.
10174
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010175 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10176 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010177
10178
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010179timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010180 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10182 yes | yes | yes | no
10183 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010184 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010185 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10186 as explained at the top of this document.
10187
10188 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10189 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10190 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010191 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10192 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10193 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10194 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010195 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10196 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10197 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010198 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010199 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010200 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10201 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010202 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10203 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010204
10205 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10206 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10207 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10208 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010209 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010210 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010212 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010213
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010214 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010215
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010216
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010217timeout client-fin <timeout>
10218 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10220 yes | yes | yes | no
10221 Arguments :
10222 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10223 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10224 as explained at the top of this document.
10225
10226 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10227 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10228 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10229 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10230 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10231 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10232 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010233 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10234 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10235 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010236
10237 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10238 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10239 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10240
10241 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10242
10243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010244timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010245 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10247 yes | no | yes | yes
10248 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010249 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010250 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10251 as explained at the top of this document.
10252
10253 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010254 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010255 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010256 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010257 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10258 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010259
10260 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10261 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10262 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10263 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010264 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010265 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10266
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010267 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010269
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010270timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10271 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10273 yes | yes | yes | yes
10274 Arguments :
10275 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10276 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10277 as explained at the top of this document.
10278
10279 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10280 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10281 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10282 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10283 once the request has started to present itself.
10284
10285 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10286 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10287 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10288 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10289 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10290
10291 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10292 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10293 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10294 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10295
10296 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10297 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010298 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010299 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10300 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010301 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010302
10303 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10304 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10305 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10306 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10307
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010308 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10309 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010310 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10311
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010312 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10313
10314
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010315timeout http-request <timeout>
10316 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010318 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010319 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010320 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10322 as explained at the top of this document.
10323
10324 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10325 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10326 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10327 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10328 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10329 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10330 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010331 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10332 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10333 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10334 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010335 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010336 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10337 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010338
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010339 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10340 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10341 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10342 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10343 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010344 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010345
10346 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10347 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010348 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010349 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10350 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10351
10352 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010353 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10354 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10355 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010356
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010357 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010358 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010359
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010360
10361timeout queue <timeout>
10362 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10364 yes | no | yes | yes
10365 Arguments :
10366 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10367 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10368 as explained at the top of this document.
10369
10370 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10371 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10372 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10373 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10374 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10375
10376 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10377 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10378 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10379 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10380
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010381 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010382
10383
10384timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010385 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10387 yes | no | yes | yes
10388 Arguments :
10389 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10390 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10391 as explained at the top of this document.
10392
10393 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10394 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10395 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10396 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10397 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10398 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10399 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10400
10401 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10402 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10403 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10404 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10405 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010406 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010407 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010408 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10409 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010410 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10411 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010412
10413 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10414 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10415 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10416 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010417 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010418 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10419
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010420 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010421
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010422
10423timeout server-fin <timeout>
10424 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10426 yes | no | yes | yes
10427 Arguments :
10428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10430 as explained at the top of this document.
10431
10432 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10433 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10434 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10435 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10436 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10437 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10438 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10439 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10440 situations, it should not be needed.
10441
10442 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10443 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10444 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10445
10446 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10447
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010448
10449timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010450 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10452 yes | yes | yes | yes
10453 Arguments :
10454 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10455 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10456 as explained at the top of this document.
10457
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010458 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10459 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10460 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010461
10462 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10463 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10464 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10465 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010466 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010467
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010468 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010469
10470
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010471timeout tunnel <timeout>
10472 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10474 yes | no | yes | yes
10475 Arguments :
10476 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10477 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10478 as explained at the top of this document.
10479
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010480 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010481 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10482 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10483 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010484 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10485 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010486 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10487 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10488 specified.
10489
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010490 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10491 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10492 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10493 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10494 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10495 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10496 state.
10497
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010498 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10499 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10500 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10501 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010503
10504 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10505 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10506 forget about it.
10507
10508 Example :
10509 defaults http
10510 option http-server-close
10511 timeout connect 5s
10512 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010513 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010514 timeout server 30s
10515 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10516
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010517 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010518
10519
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010520transparent (deprecated)
10521 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010523 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010524 Arguments : none
10525
10526 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10527 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10528 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10529 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10530 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10531 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10532 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10533 appropriate server.
10534
10535 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10536
10537 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10538 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10539
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010540 See also: "option transparent"
10541
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010542unique-id-format <string>
10543 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10545 yes | yes | yes | no
10546 Arguments :
10547 <string> is a log-format string.
10548
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010549 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10550 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10551 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10552 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010553
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010554 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10555 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10556 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10557 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10558 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10559 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10560 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10561 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010562
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010563 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10564 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010565
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010566 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010567
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010568 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010569
10570 will generate:
10571
10572 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10573
10574 See also: "unique-id-header"
10575
10576unique-id-header <name>
10577 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10579 yes | yes | yes | no
10580 Arguments :
10581 <name> is the name of the header.
10582
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010583 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10584 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010585
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010586 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010587
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010588 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010589 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10590
10591 will generate:
10592
10593 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10594
10595 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010596
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010597use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010598 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10600 no | yes | yes | no
10601 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010602 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10603 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010604
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010605 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10606 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010607
10608 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10609 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10610 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010611 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010612 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010613 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10614 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010615
10616 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10617 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10618 assign the backend.
10619
10620 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10621 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10622 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10623 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10624 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10625 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10626
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010627 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010628 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010629 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10630 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10631 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10632
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010633 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10634 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10635 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10636 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10637 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10638 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10639 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10640 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10641 cannot be forced from the request.
10642
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010643 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010644 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10645 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10646
10647 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10648 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010649
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010650use-fcgi-app <name>
10651 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10653 no | no | yes | yes
10654 Arguments :
10655 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10656
10657 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010658
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010659use-server <server> if <condition>
10660use-server <server> unless <condition>
10661 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10663 no | no | yes | yes
10664 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010665 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010666
10667 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10668
10669 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10670 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10671 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10672
10673 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10674 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10675 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10676 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10677 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10678 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10679 matches will assign the server.
10680
10681 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10682 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10683 with the next rules until one matches.
10684
10685 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10686 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10687 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10688 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10689
10690 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10691 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10692 stripped.
10693
10694 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10695 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10696 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10697 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10698
10699 Example :
10700 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10701 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10702 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10703 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10704 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10705 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010706 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010707 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10708 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10709
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010710 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010711
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010712
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107135. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010714--------------------------
10715
10716The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10717depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10718settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10719written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10720described in this section.
10721
10722
107235.1. Bind options
10724-----------------
10725
10726The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10727as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10728no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10729parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10730while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10731provided immediately after the setting name.
10732
10733The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10734
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010735accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10736 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10737 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10738 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10739 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10740 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10741 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10742 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10743 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10744 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010745 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10746 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10747 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010749accept-proxy
10750 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010751 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10752 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010753 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10754 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10755 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10756 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010757 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010758 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10759 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010760 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10761 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010762
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010763allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010764 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010765 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010766 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010767 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10768 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010769
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010770alpn <protocols>
10771 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10772 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10773 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010774 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010775 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010776 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10777 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10778 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10779 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10780 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10781 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10782 preference, like below :
10783
10784 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010785
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010786backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010787 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010788 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10789
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010790curves <curves>
10791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10792 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10793 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10794 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10795 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10796 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10797
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010798ecdhe <named curve>
10799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010800 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10801 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010802
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010803ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10805 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10806 client's certificate.
10807
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010808ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10810 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10811 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10812 error is ignored.
10813
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010814ca-sign-file <cafile>
10815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10816 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10817 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10818 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10819 'generate-certificates' for details.
10820
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010821ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10823 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10824 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10825 'generate-certificates' for details.
10826
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010827ciphers <ciphers>
10828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10829 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010830 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010831 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010832 information and recommendations see e.g.
10833 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10834 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10835 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10836
10837ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10838 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10839 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10840 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10841 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010842 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10843 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010844
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010845crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10847 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10848 to verify client's certificate.
10849
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010850crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010851 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10852 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10853 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10854 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10855 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10856 file.
10857
10858 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10859 are loaded.
10860
10861 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010862 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010863 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10864 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10865 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10866 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010867 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10868 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010869 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010870
10871 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10872 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10873 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10874 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010875 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10876 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010877
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010878 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010879
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010880 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010881 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010882 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10883 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010884 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10885 clients).
10886
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010887 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10888 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10889 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10890 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10891 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10892 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10893 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10894 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10895 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10896 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10897 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10898 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10899 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10900
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010901 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10902 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10903 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10904 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10905 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10906
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010907 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10908 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10909 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10910 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010911
10912 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10913 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10914 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10915 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10916 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10917 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10918 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10919 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10920 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10921
10922 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10923
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010924 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010925 a cert bundle.
10926
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010927 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010928 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10929 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10930 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10931 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10932 provide multi-cert support.
10933
10934 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10935
10936 Filename | CN | SAN
10937 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10938 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010939 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010940 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10941 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10942
10943 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10944 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10945 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10946 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010947 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10948 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10949 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010950
10951 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10952 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10953
10954 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10955 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10956 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10957
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010958crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010959 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010961 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010962 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010963
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010964crt-list <file>
10965 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010966 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10967 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010968
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010969 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10970
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010971 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10972 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010973 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010974 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010975
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010976 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10977 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10978 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10979 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10980 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10981 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10982 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10983 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010984
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010985 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010986 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010987 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10988 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10989 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010990
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010991 crt-list file example:
10992 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010993 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010994 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010995 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010996
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010997defer-accept
10998 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10999 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11000 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011001 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011002 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11003 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11004 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11005 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11006 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11007 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11008 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11009
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011010expose-fd listeners
11011 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11012 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011013 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11014 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011016
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011017force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011018 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011019 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011020 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011021 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011022
11023force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011024 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011025 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011026 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011027
11028force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011029 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011030 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011031 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011032
11033force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011034 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011035 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011036 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011037
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011038force-tlsv13
11039 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11040 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011041 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011042
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011043generate-certificates
11044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11045 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11046 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11047 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11048 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11049 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11050 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11051 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11052 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11053 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11054 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11055
11056 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11057 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011058 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011059 certificate is used many times.
11060
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011061gid <gid>
11062 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11063 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11064 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11065 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11066 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11067
11068group <group>
11069 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11070 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11071 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11072 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11073 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11074
11075id <id>
11076 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11077 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11078 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11079 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11080
11081interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011082 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11083 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11084 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11085 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11086 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11087 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011088 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11089 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11090 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11091 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11092 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11093 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011094
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011095level <level>
11096 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11097 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11098 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011099 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011100 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11101 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11102 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011103 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011104 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011105 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011106 all counters).
11107
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011108severity-output <format>
11109 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11110 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11111 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11112 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11113 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11114 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11115 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11116 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11117 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11118 rfc5424 convention.
11119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011120maxconn <maxconn>
11121 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11122 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11123 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11124 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11125 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11126 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11127 eat all memory.
11128
11129mode <mode>
11130 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11131 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11132 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11133 UNIX sockets.
11134
11135mss <maxseg>
11136 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11137 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11138 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11139 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11140 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11141 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11142 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11143 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11144 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11145 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11146 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11147
11148name <name>
11149 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11150 page.
11151
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011152namespace <name>
11153 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11154 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11155 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11156 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11157
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011158nice <nice>
11159 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11160 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11161 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11162 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11163 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11164 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11165 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11166 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11167 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11168 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11169 one for an RDP socket.
11170
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011171no-ca-names
11172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11173 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11174
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011175no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011177 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011178 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011179 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011180 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11181 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011182
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011183no-tls-tickets
11184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11185 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11186 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011187 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11188 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011189
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011190no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011192 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011193 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011194 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011195 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11196 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011197
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011198no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011200 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011201 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011202 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011203 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11204 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011205
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011206no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011208 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011209 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011210 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011211 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11212 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011213
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011214no-tlsv13
11215 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11216 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11217 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11218 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011219 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11220 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011221
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011222npn <protocols>
11223 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11224 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11225 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011226 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011227 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011228 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11229 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11230 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11231 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11232 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011233
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011234prefer-client-ciphers
11235 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11236 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11237 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011238 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11239 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11240 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011241
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011242process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011243 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011244 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011245 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011246 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11247 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11248 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11249 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011250 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011251 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11252 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11253 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11254 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11255 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011256
11257 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11258
11259 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11260 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11261 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11262 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11263 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11264 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11265 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11266 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011267
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011268proto <name>
11269 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11270 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11271 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11272 in haproxy -vv.
11273 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11274 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011275 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011276 h2" on the bind line.
11277
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011278ssl
11279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011280 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011281 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11282 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011283 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11284 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011285
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011286ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11287 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11288 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11289 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11290
11291ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11292 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11293 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11294 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11295
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011296strict-sni
11297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11298 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11299 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11300 See the "crt" option for more information.
11301
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011302tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011303 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011304 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11305 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011306 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011307 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11308 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11309 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11310 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11311 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11312 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11313 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11314
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011315tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011316 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011317 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11318 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11319 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11320 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11321 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11322 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11323 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011324 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11325 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11326 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011327
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011328tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11329 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011330 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11331 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11332 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11333 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11334 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11335 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11336 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11337 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11338 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11339 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011340 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11341 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11342
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011343transparent
11344 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11345 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11346 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11347 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11348 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11349 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11350 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11351 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11352 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11353 so check for support with your vendor.
11354
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011355v4v6
11356 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11357 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11358 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11359 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011360 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011361
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011362v6only
11363 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11364 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11365 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011366 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11367 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011368
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011369uid <uid>
11370 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11371 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11372 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11373 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11374 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11375
11376user <user>
11377 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11378 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11379 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11380 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11381 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11382
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011383verify [none|optional|required]
11384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11385 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11386 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11387 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11388 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011389 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11390 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11391 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11392 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011393
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113945.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011395------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011397The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11398which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11399arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11400settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11401after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11402Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11403address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011405 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011406 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011407
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011408Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11409keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011411The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011412
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011413addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011414 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011415 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11416 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11417 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11418 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11419 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011420
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011421agent-check
11422 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011423 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011424 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11425 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11426 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011427
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011428 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011429 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011430 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11431 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11432 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011433
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011434 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11435 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11436 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11437 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11438 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011439
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011440 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011441 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011442
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011443 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11444 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11445 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011446
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011447 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11448 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11449 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011450
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011451 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11452 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11453 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11454 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11455 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011456 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011457 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011458
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011459 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11460 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011461
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011462 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11463 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11464 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11465 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11466 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11467 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11468 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11469 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11470 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011471
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011472 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11473 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011474 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11475 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11476 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011477 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011478
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011479 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011480 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011481
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011482agent-send <string>
11483 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11484 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11485 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11486 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11487 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11488
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011489agent-inter <delay>
11490 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11491 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11492
11493 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11494 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11495 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11496 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11497 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11498 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11499 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11500 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11501 of backends use the same servers.
11502
11503 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11504
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011505agent-addr <addr>
11506 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11507
11508 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11509 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11510 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11511 hostname, it will be resolved.
11512
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011513agent-port <port>
11514 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11515
11516 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11517
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011518allow-0rtt
11519 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011520 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11521 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011522
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011523alpn <protocols>
11524 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11525 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11526 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011527 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011528 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11529 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11530 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11531 now obsolete NPN extension.
11532 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11533 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11534
11535 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011537backup
11538 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11539 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11540 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11541 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011542 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11543 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011544
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011545ca-file <cafile>
11546 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11547 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11548 server's certificate.
11549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011550check
11551 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011552 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11553 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11554 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11555 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11556 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11557 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11558 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011559 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11560 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011561 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11562 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011563
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011564check-send-proxy
11565 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11566 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11567 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11568 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11569 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11570 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11571 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11572
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011573check-alpn <protocols>
11574 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11575 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11576 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11577
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011578check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011579 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011580 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11581 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011582
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011583check-ssl
11584 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11585 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11586 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11587 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011588 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011589 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11590 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011591 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011592 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11593 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011594
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011595check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011596 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011597 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11598 for normal traffic.
11599
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011600ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11602 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11603 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011604 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11605 information and recommendations see e.g.
11606 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11607 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11608 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011609
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011610ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11612 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11613 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11614 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011615 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11616 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11617 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011619cookie <value>
11620 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11621 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11622 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11623 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11624 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11625 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11626 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11627
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011628crl-file <crlfile>
11629 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11630 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11631 to verify server's certificate.
11632
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011633crt <cert>
11634 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11635 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11636 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11637 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11638 certificate request.
11639
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011640disabled
11641 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11642 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11643 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11644 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11645 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011646 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011647
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011648enabled
11649 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11650 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11651 default value.
11652 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11653 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011655error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011656 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11657 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11658 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011660 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011662fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011663 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11664 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11665 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11666
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011667force-sslv3
11668 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11669 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011670 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011671 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011672
11673force-tlsv10
11674 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011675 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011676 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011677
11678force-tlsv11
11679 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011680 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011681 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011682
11683force-tlsv12
11684 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011685 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011686 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011687
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011688force-tlsv13
11689 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11690 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011691 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011693id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011694 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11695 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11696 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011697
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011698init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11699 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11700 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011701 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011702 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11703 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11704 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11705 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11706 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11707 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11708 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11709 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11710 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011711 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011712 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11713 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11714 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11715 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11716 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11717 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011718 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011719
11720 Example:
11721 defaults
11722 # never fail on address resolution
11723 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011725inter <delay>
11726fastinter <delay>
11727downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011728 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11729 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11730 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11731 between checks depending on the server state :
11732
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011733 Server state | Interval used
11734 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11735 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11736 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11737 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11738 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11739 or yet unchecked. |
11740 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11741 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11742 | "inter" otherwise.
11743 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011745 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11746 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11747 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11748 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011749 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11750 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11751 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11752 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11753 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011755maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011756 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11757 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011758 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11759 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011760 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11761 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11762 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11763 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11764
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011765 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11766 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11767 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11768 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11769 than 50 concurrent requests.
11770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011771maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011772 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11773 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11774 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11775 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11776 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11777 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11778 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11779
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011780max-reuse <count>
11781 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11782 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11783 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11784 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11785 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11786 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11787 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11788 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011790minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011791 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11792 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11793 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11794 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11795 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11796 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011797 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011798 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011799
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011800namespace <name>
11801 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11802 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11803 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11804 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11805
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011806no-agent-check
11807 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11808 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11809 default value.
11810 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11811 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11812
11813no-backup
11814 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11815 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11816 default value.
11817 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11818 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11819
11820no-check
11821 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11822 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11823 default value.
11824 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11825 "default-server" "check" setting.
11826
11827no-check-ssl
11828 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11829 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11830 default value.
11831 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11832 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11833
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011834no-send-proxy
11835 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11836 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11837 default value.
11838 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11839 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11840
11841no-send-proxy-v2
11842 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11843 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11844 default value.
11845 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11846 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11847
11848no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11849 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11850 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11851 default value.
11852 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11853 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11854
11855no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11856 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11857 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11858 default value.
11859 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11860 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11861
11862no-ssl
11863 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11864 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11865 default value.
11866 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11867 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11868
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011869no-ssl-reuse
11870 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11871 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11872 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11873 and for paranoid users.
11874
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011875no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011876 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11877 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011878 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011879
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011880 Supported in default-server: No
11881
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011882no-tls-tickets
11883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11884 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11885 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011886 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11887 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011888 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011889
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011890no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011891 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011892 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11893 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011894 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11895 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011896 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011897
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011898 Supported in default-server: No
11899
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011900no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011901 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011902 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11903 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011904 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11905 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011906 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011907
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011908 Supported in default-server: No
11909
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011910no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011911 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011912 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11913 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011914 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11915 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011916 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011917
11918 Supported in default-server: No
11919
11920no-tlsv13
11921 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11922 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11923 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11924 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11925 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011926 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011927
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011928 Supported in default-server: No
11929
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011930no-verifyhost
11931 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11932 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11933 default value.
11934 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11935 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011936
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011937no-tfo
11938 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11939 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11940 default value.
11941 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11942 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11943
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011944non-stick
11945 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11946 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11947 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11948
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011949npn <protocols>
11950 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11951 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11952 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011953 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011954 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11955 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11956 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011958observe <mode>
11959 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11960 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11961 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11962 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11963 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11964 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011965 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011966
11967 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011969on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011970 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11971 Currently, four modes are available:
11972 - fastinter: force fastinter
11973 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11974 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11975 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11976 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11977
11978 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11979
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011980on-marked-down <action>
11981 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11982 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011983 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11984 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11985 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11986 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11987 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11988 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11989 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11990 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011991
11992 Actions are disabled by default
11993
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011994on-marked-up <action>
11995 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11996 Currently one action is available:
11997 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11998 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11999 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12000 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012001 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12002 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012003 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12004 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12005
12006 Actions are disabled by default
12007
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012008pool-max-conn <max>
12009 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12010 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12011 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12012 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12013 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12014 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12015
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012016pool-purge-delay <delay>
12017 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012018 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012019 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012021port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012022 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12023 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12024 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12025 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12026 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12027 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12028
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012029proto <name>
12030
12031 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12032 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12033 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12034 reported in haproxy -vv.
12035 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12036 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012038redir <prefix>
12039 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12040 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12041 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12042 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12043 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12044 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12045 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12046 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012047 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012048 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012049 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12050 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12051 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12052 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12053
12054 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012056rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012057 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12058 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12059 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12060
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012061resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12062 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12063 server.
12064
12065 Available options:
12066
12067 * allow-dup-ip
12068 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12069 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12070 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12071 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12072 For such case, simply enable this option.
12073 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12074
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012075 * ignore-weight
12076 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12077 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12078 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12079
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012080 * prevent-dup-ip
12081 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12082 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12083 same fqdn.
12084 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12085
12086 Example:
12087 backend b_myapp
12088 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12089 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12090 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12091
12092 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12093 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12094 it
12095 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12096 different address
12097
12098 Default value: not set
12099
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012100resolve-prefer <family>
12101 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12102 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12103 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12104 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12105
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012106 Default value: ipv6
12107
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012108 Example:
12109
12110 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012111
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012112resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012113 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012114 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012115 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012116 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12117 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012118 configured network, another address is selected.
12119
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012120 Example:
12121
12122 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012123
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012124resolvers <id>
12125 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12126 hostname.
12127
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012128 Example:
12129
12130 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012131
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012132 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012133
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012134send-proxy
12135 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12136 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12137 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12138 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012139 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12140 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12141 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12142 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12143 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12144 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12145 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12146 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12147 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12148 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012149 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12150 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012151
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012152send-proxy-v2
12153 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12154 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12155 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12156 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012157 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12158 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12159 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12160 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012161
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012162proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12163 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12164 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012165 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12166 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012167 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12168 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012169 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012170
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012171send-proxy-v2-ssl
12172 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12173 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12174 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12175 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12176 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12177 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12178 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012179 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12180 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012181
12182send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12183 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12184 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12185 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12186 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12187 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12188 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12189 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12190 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012191 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12192 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012193
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012194slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012195 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12196 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12197 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12198 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12199 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12200 parameters :
12201
12202 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12203 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12204
12205 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12206 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12207 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12208 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12209
12210 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12211 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12212 seen as failed.
12213
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012214sni <expression>
12215 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12216 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12217 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12218 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012219 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12220 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012221 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012222 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12223 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012224
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012225source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012226source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012227source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012228 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12229 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12230 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12231 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12232
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012233 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12234 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12235 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12236 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12237 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12238 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12239 server.
12240
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012241 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12242 specifying the source address without port(s).
12243
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012244ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012245 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12246 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12247 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12248 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12249 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12250 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012251 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12252 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012253
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012254ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12255 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12256 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12257 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12258
12259ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12260 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12261 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12262 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12263
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012264ssl-reuse
12265 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12266 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12267 default value.
12268 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12269 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12270
12271stick
12272 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12273 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12274 default value.
12275 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12276 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012277
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012278socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012279 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012280 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12281 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12282
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012283tcp-ut <delay>
12284 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12285 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12286 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012287 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012288 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12289 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12290 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12291 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12292 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12293 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12294 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12295 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12296 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12297
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012298tfo
12299 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12300 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12301 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12302 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12303 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012304 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012306track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012307 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12308 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12309 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12310 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012311 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12312
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012313tls-tickets
12314 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12315 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12316 default value.
12317 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12318 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012319
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012320verify [none|required]
12321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012322 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012323 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12324 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012325 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012326 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12327 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12328 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12329 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12330 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12331 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12332 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12333 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012334
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012335verifyhost <hostname>
12336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012337 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12338 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12339 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12340 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12341 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12342 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12343 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12344 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012346weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012347 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12348 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12349 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012350 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12351 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12352 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12353 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12354 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12355 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012356
12357
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123585.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12359-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012360
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012361HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12362using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12363configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012364This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12365can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12366workload.
12367This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12368resolution at run time.
12369Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12370carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12371
12372
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123735.3.1. Global overview
12374----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012375
12376As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12377different steps of the process life:
12378
12379 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12380 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12381 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12382
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012383 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12384 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012385
12386A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12387 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12388 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12389 resolution to know this new IP.
12390
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012391When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012392HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012393SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12394from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12395will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12396will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012397
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012398A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012399 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012400 first valid response.
12401
12402 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12403 servers return an error.
12404
12405
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124065.3.2. The resolvers section
12407----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012408
12409This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012410HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12411contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012412
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012413When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12414uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12415is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12416answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12417
12418When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012419used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012420
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012421 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12422 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12423 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012424
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012425 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12426 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012427
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012428 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12429 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12430 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012431
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012432For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12433following scenarios are possible:
12434
12435 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12436 ignored
12437
12438 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12439 applied
12440
12441 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12442 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12443
12444 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12445 retries the query with a new type
12446
12447 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12448 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012449
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012450As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12451a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012452<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012453
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012454
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012455resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012456 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012457
12458A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12459
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012460accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012461 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012462 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012463 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12464 by RFC 6891)
12465
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012466 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12467
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012468nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12469 DNS server description:
12470 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12471 <ip> : IP address of the server
12472 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12473
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012474parse-resolv-conf
12475 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12476 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12477 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12478
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012479hold <status> <period>
12480 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12481 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012482 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012483 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012484 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12485 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12486 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12487
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012488 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012489
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012490resolve_retries <nb>
12491 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12492 giving up.
12493 Default value: 3
12494
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012495 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12496 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12497 type.
12498
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012499timeout <event> <time>
12500 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12501 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12502 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012503 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12504 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012505 Default value: 1s
12506 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012507 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012508 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012509 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12510 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12511
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012512 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012513
12514 resolvers mydns
12515 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12516 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012517 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012518 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012519 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012520 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012521 hold other 30s
12522 hold refused 30s
12523 hold nx 30s
12524 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012525 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012526 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012527
12528
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200125296. Cache
12530---------
12531
12532HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12533(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12534RAM.
12535
12536The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12537this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12538
12539If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12540independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12541when we try to allocate a new one.
12542
12543The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12544
12545It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12546"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12547for more details.
12548
12549When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12550replaced by "<CACHE>".
12551
12552
125536.1. Limitation
12554----------------
12555
12556The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12557
12558- If the response is not a 200
12559- If the response contains a Vary header
12560- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12561- If the response is not cacheable
12562
12563- If the request is not a GET
12564- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12565- If the request contains an Authorization header
12566
12567
125686.2. Setup
12569-----------
12570
12571To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12572the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12573
12574
125756.2.1. Cache section
12576---------------------
12577
12578cache <name>
12579 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12580 size of cache is mandatory.
12581
12582total-max-size <megabytes>
12583 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12584 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12585
12586max-object-size <bytes>
12587 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12588 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12589 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12590
12591max-age <seconds>
12592 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12593 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12594 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12595 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12596 default.
12597
12598
125996.2.2. Proxy section
12600---------------------
12601
12602http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12603 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12604 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12605 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12606 after this one.
12607
12608http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12609 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12610 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12611 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12612 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12613
12614
12615Example:
12616
12617 backend bck1
12618 mode http
12619
12620 http-request cache-use foobar
12621 http-response cache-store foobar
12622 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12623
12624 cache foobar
12625 total-max-size 4
12626 max-age 240
12627
12628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126297. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12630----------------------------------
12631
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012632HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012633client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12634The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12635these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12636but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12637data called patterns.
12638
12639
126407.1. ACL basics
12641---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012642
12643The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12644content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12645from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12646simple :
12647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012648 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012649 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012650 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12651 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12654adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012655
12656In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012658 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012659
12660This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12661Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12662and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012663an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12664conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12665as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12666are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012667
12668ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12669'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12670which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12671
12672There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12673performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012675The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12676specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12677this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012678methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12679ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012680
12681Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12682 - boolean
12683 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12684 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12685 - string
12686 - data block
12687
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012688Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12689converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12690would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12691The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12692which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12693
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012694Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12695keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12696fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12697which are summarized in the table below :
12698
12699 +---------------------+-----------------+
12700 | Sample or converter | Default |
12701 | output type | matching method |
12702 +---------------------+-----------------+
12703 | boolean | bool |
12704 +---------------------+-----------------+
12705 | integer | int |
12706 +---------------------+-----------------+
12707 | ip | ip |
12708 +---------------------+-----------------+
12709 | string | str |
12710 +---------------------+-----------------+
12711 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12712 +---------------------+-----------------+
12713
12714Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12715matching method, see below.
12716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012717The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12718 - boolean
12719 - integer or integer range
12720 - IP address / network
12721 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12722 - regular expression
12723 - hex block
12724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012725The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12726
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012727 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12728 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012729 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012730 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012731 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012732 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012733 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012735The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12736read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12737if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12738lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12739will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12740beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12741a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12742lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12743exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12744
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012745The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12746parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12747ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12748a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12749check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12750
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012751The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12752socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12753file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012755Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12756loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12757
12758 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12759
12760In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12761the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12762case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12763as well.
12764
12765The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12766sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12767do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12768methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12769is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012770obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012771followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12772default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12773that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12774string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12775
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012776The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12777By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12778string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12779resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12780server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012781waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012782flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12783function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012785There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12786sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12787be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012788
12789 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12790 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012791 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12792 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12793 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12794 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012795
12796 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12797 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012798 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012799
12800 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012802
12803 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012804 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012806 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012807 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12808
12809 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12810 binary or string samples.
12811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012812 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12813 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12816 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12817 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12820 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12823 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012825 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12826 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012828 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12829 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012830 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12833 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12834 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012835
12836For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12837request, it is possible to do :
12838
12839 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12840
12841In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12842buffer, one would use the following acl :
12843
12844 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12845
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012846On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12847possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12848
12849 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012851All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12852criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12853method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12854to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12855criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12856the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012859the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12860For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12863 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12864 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12865 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012866
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012867
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012868The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12869types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12870combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12871brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12872default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012874 +-------------------------------------------------+
12875 | Input sample type |
12876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012877 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12879 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012881 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012883 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012885 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012887 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012889 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012891 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012893 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012895 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012897 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012899 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012901 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12903 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012905
12906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129077.1.1. Matching booleans
12908------------------------
12909
12910In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12911Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12912When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12913that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12914
12915Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12916return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12917"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129207.1.2. Matching integers
12921------------------------
12922
12923Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12924enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12925to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12926
12927Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12928matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12929lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012930
12931For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12932unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12933representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12934
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012935As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12936two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12937instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12938ranges and operators.
12939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012940For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012941operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12942Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12943of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012945Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012946
12947 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12948 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12949 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12950 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12951 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012953For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012954
12955 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12956
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012957This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12958
12959 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12960
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129627.1.3. Matching strings
12963-----------------------
12964
12965String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12966different forms :
12967
12968 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012969 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012970
12971 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012972 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012973
12974 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12975 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12976
12977 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12978 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12979
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012980 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012981 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12982 matches.
12983
12984 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12985 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12986 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012987
12988String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12989exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12990characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12991string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12992to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012993before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012994
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010012995Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
12996(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
12997Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
12998
12999Example:
13000 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13001 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13002
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130047.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13005---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013006
13007Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13008they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13009possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13010passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13011the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013012the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13013match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013014
13015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130167.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13017-------------------------------------
13018
13019It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13020not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13021a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13022to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13023digits may be used upper or lower case.
13024
13025Example :
13026 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13027 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13028
13029
130307.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13031---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013032
13033IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13034netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13035within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013036host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013037difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13038at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13039does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13040parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013041
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013042The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13043abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13044
13045 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13046 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13047 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13048 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13049 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13050 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13051 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13052 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13053
13054Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13055192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13056
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013057IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13058Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13059trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13060IPv6 patterns.
13061
13062HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13063following situations :
13064 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13065 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13066 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13067 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13068 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13069 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13070 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13071 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13072 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13073 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013075
130767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13077----------------------------------
13078
13079Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13080combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13081
13082 - AND (implicit)
13083 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13084 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013086A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013088 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013090Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13091indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013093For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13094"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13095requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13096is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13097
13098 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013099 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13100 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13101 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102
13103To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13104and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13105
13106 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13107 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13108 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13109 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13110
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013111 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13113 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13114 use_backend www if host_www
13115
13116It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13117expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13118be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13119the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13120
13121 The following rule :
13122
13123 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013124 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013125
13126 Can also be written that way :
13127
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013128 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013129
13130It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13131to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13132simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13133sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13134good use is the following :
13135
13136 With named ACLs :
13137
13138 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13139 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13140 monitor fail if site_dead
13141
13142 With anonymous ACLs :
13143
13144 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13145
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013146See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13147keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148
13149
131507.3. Fetching samples
13151---------------------
13152
13153Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13154against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13155sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13156ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13157of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13158available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13159
13160This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13161Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13162compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13163deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13164
13165The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13166matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13167method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13168indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13169
13170As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13171when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13172mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13173the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13174ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13175
13176Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13177multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13178when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013179incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13180are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13182all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13183
13184Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13185 - name
13186 - name(arg1)
13187 - name(arg1,arg2)
13188
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013189
131907.3.1. Converters
13191-----------------
13192
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013193Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13194of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13195is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13196was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013197has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013198unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13199
13200These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13201sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13202the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013203support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013204
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013205A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13206support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13207supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13208(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13209bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013212
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001321351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13214 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13215 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13216 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13217 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13218 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13219
13220 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013221 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13222 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013223 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13224 frontend http-in
13225 bind *:8081
13226 default_backend servers
13227 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13228 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13229
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013230add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013231 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013232 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013233 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13234 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013235 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013236 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13237 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13238 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13239 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013241 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013242
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013243aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13244 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13245 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13246 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13247 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13248 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13249 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13250
13251 Example:
13252 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13253 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13254
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013255and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013256 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013257 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013258 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13259 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013260 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013261 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13262 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13263 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13264 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013266 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013267
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013268b64dec
13269 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13270 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13271
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013272base64
13273 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013274 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013275 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13276
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013277bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013278 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013279 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013280 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013281 presence of a flag).
13282
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013283bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13284 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13285 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013286 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013287
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013288concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13289 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13290 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13291 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13292 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13293 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13294 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13295 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13296 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13297 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13298 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013299 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013300 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013301 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013302
13303 Example:
13304 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13305 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13306 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13307 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13308
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013309cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013310 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13311 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013312
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013313crc32([<avalanche>])
13314 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13315 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13316 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13317 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13318 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13319 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13320 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13321 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13322 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13323 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013324 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13325
13326crc32c([<avalanche>])
13327 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13328 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13329 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13330 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13331 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13332 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13333 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13334 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013335
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013336da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013337 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13338 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13339 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13340 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013341 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013342 configuration language.
13343
13344 Example:
13345 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013346 bind *:8881
13347 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013348 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013349
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013350debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13351 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13352 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13353 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13354 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13355 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13356 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13357 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13358 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13359 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13360 printable sample types.
13361
13362 Example:
13363 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013364
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013365div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013366 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13367 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013368 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013369 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13370 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013371 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013372 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13373 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13374 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13375 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013377 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013378
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013379djb2([<avalanche>])
13380 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13381 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13382 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13383 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13384 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13385 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13386 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013387 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13388 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013389
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013390even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013391 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013392 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13393
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013394field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13395 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13396 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13397 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13398 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13399 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13400 fields.
13401
13402 Example :
13403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13405 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13406 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13407 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013408
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013409hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013410 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013411 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013412 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013413 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013414
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013415hex2i
13416 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013417 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013418
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013419http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013420 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13421 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013422 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13423 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13424 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13425 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13426 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13427 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13428 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13429 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013431in_table(<table>)
13432 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13433 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13434 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013435 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013436 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13437
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013438ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13439 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013440 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013441 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13442 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13443 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13444 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13445 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013446
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013447json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013449 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013450 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013451 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13452 of errors:
13453 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13454 bytes, ...)
13455 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13456 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13457
13458 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13459 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13460 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13461 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13462 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13463 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013464 - "ascii" : never fails;
13465 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13466 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013467 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013468 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013469 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13470 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13471
13472 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013473 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013474
13475 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013476 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013477 capture request header user-agent len 150
13478 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013479
13480 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13481 GET / HTTP/1.0
13482 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13483
13484 Output log:
13485 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13486
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013487language(<value>[,<default>])
13488 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13489 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13490 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13491 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13492 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13493 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13494 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13495 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13496 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013497 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013498 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13499 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013500
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013501 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013502
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013503 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13504 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013506 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13507 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13508 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13509 use_backend spanish if es
13510 use_backend french if fr
13511 use_backend english if en
13512 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013513
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013514length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013515 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13516 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13517 type. The result is of type integer.
13518
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013519lower
13520 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13521 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13522 type. The result is of type string.
13523
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013524ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13525 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13526 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13527 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13528 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13529 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13530 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13531
13532 Example :
13533
13534 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013535 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013536 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013538map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13539map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13540map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13541 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13542 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13543 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13544 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13545 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13546 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13547 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13548 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013550 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13551 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13552 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013553
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013554 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013555 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013556
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013557 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13558 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13559 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13560 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013561 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13562 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013563 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13564 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13565 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13566 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13567 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13568 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13569 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13570 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013571 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13572 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13573 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013574 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13575 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13576 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13577 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13578 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013579
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013580 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13581 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13582 the corresponding match text.
13583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013584 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13585 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13586 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13587 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13588 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013590 Example :
13591
13592 # this is a comment and is ignored
13593 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13594 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13595 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13596 | | | `---------- value
13597 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13598 | `---------------------------- key
13599 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13600
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013601mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013602 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13603 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013604 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013605 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013606 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013607 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13608 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13609 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13610 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013611 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013612 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013613
13614mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013615 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013616 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13617 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013618 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013619 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013620 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013621 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13622 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13623 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13624 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013625 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013626 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013627
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013628nbsrv
13629 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13630 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13631 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13632 map lookup.
13633
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013634neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013635 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13636 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13637 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13638 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013639
13640not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013641 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013642 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013643 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013644 absence of a flag).
13645
13646odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013647 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013648 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13649
13650or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013651 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013652 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013653 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13654 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013655 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013656 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13657 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13658 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013661 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013662
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013663protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13664 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13665 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13666 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13667 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13668 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13669 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13670 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13671 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13672 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13673 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13674 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13675
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013676regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013677 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13678 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13679 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13680 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13681 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13682 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13683 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13684 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13685 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13686 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013687 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13688 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13689 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13690 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013691
13692 Example :
13693
13694 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13695 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13696 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13697 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13698
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013699capture-req(<id>)
13700 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13701 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13702
13703 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013704 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13705 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013706
13707capture-res(<id>)
13708 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13709 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13710
13711 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013712 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13713 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013714
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013715sdbm([<avalanche>])
13716 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13717 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13718 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13719 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13720 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13721 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13722 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013723 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13724 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013725
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013726set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013727 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13728 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13729 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013730 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013731 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13732 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013733 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013734 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13735 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013736 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013737 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013738
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013739sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013740 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013741 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13742
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013743sha2([<bits>])
13744 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13745 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13746
13747 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13748 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13749
13750 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13751 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13752
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013753srv_queue
13754 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13755 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13756 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13757 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13758 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13759
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013760strcmp(<var>)
13761 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13762 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13763 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13764 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13765 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13766 shorter).
13767
13768 Example :
13769
13770 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13771 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13772 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13773
13774
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013775sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013776 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13777 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013778 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013779 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13780 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013781 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013782 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13783 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013784 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013785 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13786 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013787 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013788 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013789
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013790table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13791 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13792 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13793 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13794 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13795 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13796 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13797
13798
13799table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13800 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13801 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13802 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13803 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13804 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13805 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13806
13807table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13808 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13809 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013810 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013811 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13812 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13813
13814table_conn_cur(<table>)
13815 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13816 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13817 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13818 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13819 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13820
13821table_conn_rate(<table>)
13822 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13823 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13824 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13825 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13826 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13827
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013828table_gpt0(<table>)
13829 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13830 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13831 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13832 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13833 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13834
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013835table_gpc0(<table>)
13836 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13837 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13838 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13839 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13840 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13841
13842table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13843 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13844 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13845 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13846 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13847 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13848 sample fetch keyword.
13849
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013850table_gpc1(<table>)
13851 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13852 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13853 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13854 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13855 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13856
13857table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13860 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13861 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13862 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13863 sample fetch keyword.
13864
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013865table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013869 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13870 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13871
13872table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13873 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13874 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13875 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13876 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13877 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13878 keyword.
13879
13880table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013884 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13885 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13886
13887table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13890 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13891 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13892 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13893 keyword.
13894
13895table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013899 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13900 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13901 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13902 keyword.
13903
13904table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013908 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13909 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13910 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13911 keyword.
13912
13913table_server_id(<table>)
13914 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13915 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13916 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13917 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13918 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13919 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13920
13921table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13922 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13923 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013924 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013925 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13926 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13927 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13928 keyword.
13929
13930table_sess_rate(<table>)
13931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13933 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13934 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13935 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13936 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13937 keyword.
13938
13939table_trackers(<table>)
13940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13942 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13943 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13944 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13945 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13946 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13947 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13948 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13949 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13950
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013951upper
13952 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13953 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13954 type. The result is of type string.
13955
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013956url_dec
13957 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13958 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13959
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013960ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013961 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013962 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13963 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13964 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013965 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13966 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13967 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13968 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013969 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013970 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13971 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013972
13973 Example:
13974 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13975 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13976
13977 message Point {
13978 int32 latitude = 1;
13979 int32 longitude = 2;
13980 }
13981
13982 message PPoint {
13983 Point point = 59;
13984 }
13985
13986 message Rectangle {
13987 // One corner of the rectangle.
13988 PPoint lo = 48;
13989 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13990 PPoint hi = 49;
13991 }
13992
13993 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13994 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13995 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13996
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013997 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13998 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013999 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014000 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14001
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014002 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014003
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014004 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014005
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014006 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014007 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14008 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14009
14010 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14011 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14012 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14013
14014 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14015 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14016 interpret the previous binary sample.
14017
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014018
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014019unset-var(<var name>)
14020 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14021 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14022 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14023 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14024 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14025 response),
14026 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14027 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14028 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14029 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14030
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014031utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14032 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14033 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14034 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14035 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14036 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14037 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14038
14039 Example :
14040
14041 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014042 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014043 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14044
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014045word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14046 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14047 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14048 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14049 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14050 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14051
14052 Example :
14053 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14054 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14055 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14056 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14057 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014058
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014059wt6([<avalanche>])
14060 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14061 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14062 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14063 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14064 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14065 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14066 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014067 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14068 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014069
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014070xor(<value>)
14071 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014072 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014073 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014074 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014075 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014076 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14077 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014078 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014079 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14080 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014081 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014082 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014083
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014084xxh32([<seed>])
14085 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14086 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14087 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14088 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14089 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14090 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14091 as cryptographically secure.
14092
14093xxh64([<seed>])
14094 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14095 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14096 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14097 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14098 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14099 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14100 as cryptographically secure.
14101
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014102
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141037.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014104--------------------------------------------
14105
14106A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14107not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14108"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14109The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14110
14111always_false : boolean
14112 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14113 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14114
14115always_true : boolean
14116 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14117 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14118
14119avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014120 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14122 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14123 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14124 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14125 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14126 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14127 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14128 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14129 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14130 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14131 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14132 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14133 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014136 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14137 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14138 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14139 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014140 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14141
14142be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14143 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14144 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14145 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14146 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14147 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014148 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14149 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014150
14151 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14152 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14153 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014155be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14156 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14157 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14158 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014159 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014160 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14161 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014162
14163 Example :
14164 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14165 backend dynamic
14166 mode http
14167 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14168 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014169
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014170bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014171 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14172 of the string.
14173
14174bool(<bool>) : bool
14175 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14176 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014178connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14179 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014180 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14182 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014183
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014184 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014185 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014186 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14187
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014188 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14189 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014190
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014191 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014192 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014194 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014195 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014196 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014197 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014198
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014199 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14200 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014201 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014202 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014203
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014204cpu_calls : integer
14205 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14206 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14207 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14208 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14209 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14210 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14211
14212cpu_ns_avg : integer
14213 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14214 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14215 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14216 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14217 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14218 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14219 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14220 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14221 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14222 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14223 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14224
14225cpu_ns_tot : integer
14226 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14227 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14228 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14229 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14230 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14231 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14232 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14233 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14234 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14235 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14236 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14237 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14238 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14239
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014240date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014241 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014242
14243 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14244 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14245 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014246 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14247
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014248 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14249 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14250 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14251 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14252 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14253
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014254 Example :
14255
14256 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14257 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014258
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014259 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14260 # millisecond granularity
14261 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14262
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014263date_us : integer
14264 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14265 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14266 from the same timeval structure.
14267
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014268distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14269 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14270 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14271 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14272 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14273 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14274 list of supported tokens.
14275
14276distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14277 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14278 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14279 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14280 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14281 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14282 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14283 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14284 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14285 supported tokens.
14286
14287 Example :
14288 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14289 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14290 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14291 # send large files to the big farm
14292 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14293
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014294env(<name>) : string
14295 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14296 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14297 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14298 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14299 certain way.
14300
14301 Examples :
14302 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14303 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14304
14305 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14306 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014308fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14309 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014310 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14311 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14313 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014314 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014315 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14316 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014317
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014318fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14319 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14320 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14321 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014323fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14324 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14325 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14326 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14327 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14328 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14329 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14330 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14331 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014332
14333 Example :
14334 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14335 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14336 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14337 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14338 frontend mail
14339 bind :25
14340 mode tcp
14341 maxconn 100
14342 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14343 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14344 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14345 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014346
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014347hostname : string
14348 Returns the system hostname.
14349
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014350int(<integer>) : signed integer
14351 Returns a signed integer.
14352
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014353ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14354 Returns an ipv4.
14355
14356ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14357 Returns an ipv6.
14358
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014359lat_ns_avg : integer
14360 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14361 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14362 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14363 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14364 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14365 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14366 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14367 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14368 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14369 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14370 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14371 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14372 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14373 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14374
14375lat_ns_tot : integer
14376 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14377 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14378 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14379 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14380 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14381 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14382 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14383 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14384 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14385 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14386 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14387 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14388 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14389 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14390 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14391 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14392 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14393 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14394 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14395
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014396meth(<method>) : method
14397 Returns a method.
14398
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014399nbproc : integer
14400 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14401 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14402 and debugging purposes.
14403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14405 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14406 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14407 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014408 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14409 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14410 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014411
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014412prio_class : integer
14413 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14414 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14415 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14416
14417prio_offset : integer
14418 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14419 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14420 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14421 set-priority-offset".
14422
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014423proc : integer
14424 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14425 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14426 debugging purposes.
14427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014429 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14430 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14431 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14433 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14434 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14435 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14436 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14437
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014438rand([<range>]) : integer
14439 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14440 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14441 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14442 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14443 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14444
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014445uuid([<version>]) : string
14446 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14447 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14448 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14451 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14452 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14453 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14454 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14455 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014456 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14457 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14458
14459srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14461 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14462 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14463 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14464 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14465 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14466 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14467
14468 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14469 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470
14471srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14472 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14473 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14474 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014475 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14477 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14478 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14479
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014480srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14481 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14482 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14483 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14484 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14485 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14486 fetch methods.
14487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14489 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14490 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014491 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014492 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14493 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014494 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495 overloading servers).
14496
14497 Example :
14498 # Redirect to a separate back
14499 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14500 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14501 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14502
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014503stopping : boolean
14504 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14505 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14506 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14507
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014508str(<string>) : string
14509 Returns a string.
14510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014511table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14512 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14513 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14514
14515table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14516 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14517 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14518 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14519
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014520thread : integer
14521 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14522 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14523 and debugging purposes.
14524
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014525var(<var-name>) : undefined
14526 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014527 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14528 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014529 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014530 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14531 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014532 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014533 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14534 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014535 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014536 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145387.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539----------------------------------
14540
14541The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14542closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14543methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14544sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14545TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014546the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14547counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014548"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14549used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14550can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14551Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14552table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14553tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14554currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014556bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014557 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14558 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14559 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014561be_id : integer
14562 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14563 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14564
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014565be_name : string
14566 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14567 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014569dst : ip
14570 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14571 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14572 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14573 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014574 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14575 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14576 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14577 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14578 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14579 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014580
14581dst_conn : integer
14582 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14583 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14584 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14585 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14586 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14587 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14588 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14589 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014590
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014591dst_is_local : boolean
14592 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14593 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14594 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14595 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014596 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014597 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14598 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14599 it only once per connection.
14600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601dst_port : integer
14602 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14603 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14604 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14605 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14606 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14607 an HTTP header.
14608
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014609fc_http_major : integer
14610 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14611 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14612 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14613
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014614fc_pp_authority : string
14615 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14616 if any.
14617
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014618fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14619 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14620 header.
14621
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014622fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14623 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14624 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14625 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14626 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14627 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14628 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14629
14630fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14631 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14632 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14633 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14634 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14635 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14636 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14637
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014638fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014639 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14640 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14641 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14642 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14643
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014644fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014645 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14646 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14647 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14648 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14649
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014650fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014651 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14652 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14653 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14654 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14655
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014656fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014657 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14658 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14659 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14660 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14661
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014662fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014663 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14664 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14665 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14666 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14667
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014668fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014669 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14670 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14671 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14672 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14673
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014674fe_defbe : string
14675 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14676 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014678fe_id : integer
14679 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014680 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014681 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14682
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014683fe_name : string
14684 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14685 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14686 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14687
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014688sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014689sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14690sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14691sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014692 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14693 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14694 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014696sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014697sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14698sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14699sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014700 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14701 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14702 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14703
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014704sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014705sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14706sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14707sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014708 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14709 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014710 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14711 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14712 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014713
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014714 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014715 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14716 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014717 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14718 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14719 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014720 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14721 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14722
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014723sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14724sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14725sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14726sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14727 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14728 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14729 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14730 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14731 when a first ACL was verified.
14732
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014733sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014734sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14735sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14736sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014737 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014738 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14739
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014740sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014741sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14742sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14743sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014744 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14745 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14746 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014748sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014749sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14750sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14751sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014752 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14753 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14754 See also src_conn_rate.
14755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014756sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014757sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14758sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14759sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014760 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014761 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014762
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014763sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14764sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14765sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14766sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14767 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14768 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14769
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014770sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14771sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14772sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14773sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14774 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14775 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014777sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014778sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14779sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14780sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014781 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14782 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14783 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014784 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14785 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14786 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014787
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014788sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14789sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14790sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14791sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14792 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14793 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14794 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14795 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14796 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14797 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14798
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014799sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014800sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14801sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14802sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014803 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014804 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14805 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14806
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014807sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014808sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14809sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14810sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014811 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14812 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14813 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14814 src_http_err_rate.
14815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014816sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014817sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14818sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14819sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014820 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014821 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14822 src_http_req_cnt.
14823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014824sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014825sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14826sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14827sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014828 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14829 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14830 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14831 src_http_req_rate.
14832
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014833sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014834sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14835sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14836sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014837 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014838 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14839 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14840 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14841 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014842
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014843 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014844 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14845 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014846 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14847
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014848sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14849sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14850sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14851sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14852 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14853 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14854 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14855 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14856 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14857
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014858sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014859sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14860sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14861sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014862 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14863 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14864 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014865
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014866sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014867sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14868sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14869sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014870 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14871 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14872 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014874sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014875sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14876sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14877sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014878 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014879 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14880 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14881 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014882 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014883 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14884
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014885sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014886sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14887sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14888sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014889 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14890 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14891 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14892 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14893 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014894 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014896sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014897sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14898sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14899sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014900 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14901 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14902 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014904sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014905sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14906sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14907sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014908 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14909 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014910 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014911 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14912 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014913 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14914 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14915 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014917so_id : integer
14918 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14919 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14920 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014923 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14925 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14926 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014927 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14928 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14929 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014930 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14931 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14932 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14933 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14934 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14935 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14936 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014937
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014938 Example:
14939 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14940 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014942src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14943 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14944 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14945 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014946 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14949 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14950 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014951 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014952 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14955 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14956 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14957 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14958 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14959 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14960 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014961
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014962 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014963 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14964 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14965 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14966 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014967 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014968 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14969 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14970
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014971src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14972 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14973 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14974 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14975 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14976 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14977 was verified.
14978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014980 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014982 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014983 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014986 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14988 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014989 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14992 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14993 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14994 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014995 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014997src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014998 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015000 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015001 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015002
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015003src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15004 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15005 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15006 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15007 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15008
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015009src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15010 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15011 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15012 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15013 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015016 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015018 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15019 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015020 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15021 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15022 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015023
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015024src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15025 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15026 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15027 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15028 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15029 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15030 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15031 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015033src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015034 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015036 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015037 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015038 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015040src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15041 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15042 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15043 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15044 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015045 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015047src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015048 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015049 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15050 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015051 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15054 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15055 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15056 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015057 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015058 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15061 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15062 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15063 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015064 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015065 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15066 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015067
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015068 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015069 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015070 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015071 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015072
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015073src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15074 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15075 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15076 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15077 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15078 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15079 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15080
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015081src_is_local : boolean
15082 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15083 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15084 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15085 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015086 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015087 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15088 once per connection.
15089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015091 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15092 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15093 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15094 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15095 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015097src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015098 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15099 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15100 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15101 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15102 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104src_port : integer
15105 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15106 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15107 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15108 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015111 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015112 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15113 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15114 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015115 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015117src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15118 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15119 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15120 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15121 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015122 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15125 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15126 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15127 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15128 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15129 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15130 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15131 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15132 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015133
15134 Example :
15135 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15136 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15137 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15138 listen ssh
15139 bind :22
15140 mode tcp
15141 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015142 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015144 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015146srv_id : integer
15147 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15148 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15149 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015150
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015151srv_name : string
15152 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15153 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15154 debugging.
15155
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151567.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015157----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015159The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15160closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15161when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15162usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015163future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015164
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001516551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15166 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15167 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15168 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15169 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15170 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15171
15172 Example :
15173 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15174 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15175 # the request.
15176 frontend http-in
15177 bind *:8081
15178 default_backend servers
15179 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15180 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15181
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015182ssl_bc : boolean
15183 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15184 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15185 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15186
15187ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15188 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15189 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15190
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015191ssl_bc_alpn : string
15192 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15193 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015194 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015195 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15196 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15197 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15198 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15199 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15200 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15201
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015202ssl_bc_cipher : string
15203 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15204 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15205
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015206ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15207 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15208 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15209 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15210
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015211ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15212 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15213 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15214 session or a TLS ticket.
15215
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015216ssl_bc_npn : string
15217 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15218 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015219 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015220 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15221 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15222 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15223 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15224 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15225
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015226ssl_bc_protocol : string
15227 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15228 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15229
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015230ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015231 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015232 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15233 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015234
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015235ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15236 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15237 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15238 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15239
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015240ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15241 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15242 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15243 if session was reused or not.
15244
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015245ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15246 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15247 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15248 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15249 BoringSSL.
15250
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015251ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15252 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15253 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15256 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15257 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15258 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15259 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15260 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15263 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15264 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15265 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15266 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015267
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015268ssl_c_der : binary
15269 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15270 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15271 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015273ssl_c_err : integer
15274 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15275 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15276 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15277 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15278 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015279
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015280ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15282 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15283 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15284 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15285 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15286 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15287 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15288 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015289 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15290 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15291 LDAP v3.
15292 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15293 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295ssl_c_key_alg : string
15296 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15297 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15298 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300ssl_c_notafter : string
15301 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15302 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15303 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305ssl_c_notbefore : string
15306 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15307 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15308 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015309
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015310ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015311 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15312 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15313 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15314 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15315 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15316 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15317 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15318 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015319 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15320 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15321 LDAP v3.
15322 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15323 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325ssl_c_serial : binary
15326 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15327 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15328 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15331 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15332 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15333 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015334 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15335 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15336
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015337 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015338 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15341 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15342 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15343 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345ssl_c_used : boolean
15346 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15347 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015349ssl_c_verify : integer
15350 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15351 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15352 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15353 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015355ssl_c_version : integer
15356 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15357 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015358
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015359ssl_f_der : binary
15360 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15361 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15362 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15363
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015364ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015365 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15366 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15367 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15368 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015369 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15371 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15372 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015373 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15374 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15375 LDAP v3.
15376 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15377 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015379ssl_f_key_alg : string
15380 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15381 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15382 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384ssl_f_notafter : string
15385 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15386 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15387 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015389ssl_f_notbefore : string
15390 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15391 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15392 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015393
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015394ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015395 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15396 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15397 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15398 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15399 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15400 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15401 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15402 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015403 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15404 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15405 LDAP v3.
15406 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15407 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409ssl_f_serial : binary
15410 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15411 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15412 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015413
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015414ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15415 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15416 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15417 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15420 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15421 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15422 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424ssl_f_version : integer
15425 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15426 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15427
15428ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015429 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15430 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15431 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015433 Example :
15434 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15435 listen http-https
15436 bind :80
15437 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15438 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15439
15440ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15441 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15442 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15443
15444ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015445 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15447 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15448 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15449 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15450 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15451 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15452 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15453 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455ssl_fc_cipher : string
15456 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15457 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015458
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015459ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15460 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15461 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015462 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015463
15464ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15465 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15466 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015467 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015468
15469ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15470 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15471 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15472 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015473 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015474 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015475
15476ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15477 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15478 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015479 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015480
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015481ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15482 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15483 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15484 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015487 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15488 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015489 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15490 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15491 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15492 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015493
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015494ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15495 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15496 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15497 wait until the handshake happened.
15498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15500 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015501 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15502 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015503 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015504 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015505
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015506ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015507 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015508 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15509 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015512 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15514 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15515 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15516 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15517 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15518 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15519 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521ssl_fc_protocol : string
15522 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15523 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015524
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015525ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015526 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015527 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15528 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015529
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015530ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15531 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15532 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15533 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15536 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15537 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15538 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15539 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015540
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015541ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15542 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15543 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15544 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15545 BoringSSL.
15546
15547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548ssl_fc_sni : string
15549 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15550 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15551 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15552 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15553 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15554
15555 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15556 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15557 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015558 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015559 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15563 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15566 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15567 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015568
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015569
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155707.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15574sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15575only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15576For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15577be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15578can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15579sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15580for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15581content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015584 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15586 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15589 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015590 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015592
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015593req.hdrs : string
15594 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15595 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15596 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15597 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15598
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015599req.hdrs_bin : binary
15600 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15601 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15602 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15603 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15604 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15605 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15606
15607 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15608
15609 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15610 str: <int:length><bytes>
15611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612req.len : integer
15613req_len : integer (deprecated)
15614 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15615 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15616 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15617 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15618 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15619 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15620 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15621 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15624 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015625 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15626 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15627 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15628 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630 ACL alternatives :
15631 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15634 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15635 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15636 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15637 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 ACL alternatives :
15640 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644req.proto_http : boolean
15645req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15646 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15647 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15648 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15649 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15650 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15651 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15652 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 Example:
15655 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15656 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15657 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015658 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15661rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15662 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15663 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15664 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15665 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15666 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15667 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15668 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15671 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15672 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15673 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15674 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15675 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 ACL derivatives :
15678 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 Example :
15681 listen tse-farm
15682 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15683 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15684 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15685 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15686 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15687 persist rdp-cookie
15688 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15689 # This is only useful makes sense if
15690 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15691 stick-table type string size 204800
15692 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15693 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15694 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15697 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15700rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15701 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15702 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15703 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15704 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706 ACL derivatives :
15707 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015708
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015709req.ssl_alpn : string
15710 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15711 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15712 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15713 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15714 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15715 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015716 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015717
15718 Examples :
15719 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15720 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15721 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015722 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015723 default_backend bk_default
15724
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015725req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15726 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15727 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015728 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15729 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15730 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15731 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15732 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15735req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15736 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15737 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15738 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15739 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15740 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15741 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15742 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744req.ssl_sni : string
15745req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15746 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15747 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15748 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15749 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15750 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15751 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15752 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15753 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15754 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15755 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15756 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15757 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759 ACL derivatives :
15760 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 Examples :
15763 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15764 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15765 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15766 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15767 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015768
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015769req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15770 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15771 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15772 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15773 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15774 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15775 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15776 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15777 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15778 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780req.ssl_ver : integer
15781req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15782 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15783 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15784 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15785 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15786 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15787 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15788 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015789 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792 ACL derivatives :
15793 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015794
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015795res.len : integer
15796 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15797 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15798 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15799 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15800 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15801 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15802 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15803 content inspection.
15804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15806 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015807 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15808 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15809 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15810 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15813 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15814 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15815 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15816 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015819
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015820res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15821rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15822 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15823 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15824 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15825 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15826 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15827 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15828 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830wait_end : boolean
15831 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15832 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015833 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15835 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015836 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15838 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840 Examples :
15841 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15842 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15843 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015845 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15846 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15847 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15848 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15849 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15850 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15851 tcp-request content reject
15852
15853
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158547.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855--------------------------------------
15856
15857It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15858This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15859data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15860its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15861HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15862content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15863to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15864more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15865response are indexed.
15866
15867base : string
15868 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15869 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15870 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15871 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15872 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15873 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15874 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15875 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15876
15877 ACL derivatives :
15878 base : exact string match
15879 base_beg : prefix match
15880 base_dir : subdir match
15881 base_dom : domain match
15882 base_end : suffix match
15883 base_len : length match
15884 base_reg : regex match
15885 base_sub : substring match
15886
15887base32 : integer
15888 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15889 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15890 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015891 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15892 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15893 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894
15895base32+src : binary
15896 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15897 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15898 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15899 per-URL counters.
15900
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015901capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15902 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15903 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15904 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15905
15906capture.req.method : string
15907 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15908 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15909 because it's allocated.
15910
15911capture.req.uri : string
15912 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15913 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15914 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15915 allocated.
15916
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015917capture.req.ver : string
15918 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15919 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15920 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15921
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015922capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15923 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15924 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15925 The first entry is an index of 0.
15926 See also: "capture response header"
15927
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015928capture.res.ver : string
15929 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15930 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15931 persistent flag.
15932
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015933req.body : binary
15934 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15935 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15936 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15937 the first chunk is analyzed.
15938
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015939req.body_param([<name>) : string
15940 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15941 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15942 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15943 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15944 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15945 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15946 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15947 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15948 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15949 given.
15950
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015951req.body_len : integer
15952 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15953 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15954 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15955 "option http-buffer-request".
15956
15957req.body_size : integer
15958 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15959 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15960 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15961 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15962 "option http-buffer-request".
15963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964req.cook([<name>]) : string
15965cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15966 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15967 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15968 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15969 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15970 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15971 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15972 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15973 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15974
15975 ACL derivatives :
15976 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15977 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15978 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15979 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15980 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15981 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15982 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15983 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15986cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15987 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15988 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15991cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15992 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15993 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15994 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15995 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15998 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15999 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16000 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16001 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016002 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16004 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16005 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16006 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16009 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16010 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16011 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16012 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016013 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16016 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16017 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16018 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16019 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16020 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16021 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16022 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16023 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16026 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16027 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16028 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16029 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16032 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16033 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16034 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16035 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16036 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16037 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16038 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16039 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016040 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016042 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044 ACL derivatives :
16045 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16046 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16047 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16048 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16049 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16050 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16051 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16052 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16053
16054req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16055hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16056 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16057 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16058 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16059 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16060 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16061 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16062 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16063 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16064 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16065
16066req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16067hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16068 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16069 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16070 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16071 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16072 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016073 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16075 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16076
16077req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16078hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16079 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16080 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16081 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16082 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16083 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16084 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16085 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16086
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016087
16088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16090 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16091 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16092 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16093 basic auth is supported.
16094
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016095http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16096 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16097 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16098 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16099 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16101 basic auth is supported.
16102
16103 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016104 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16105 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16106 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16107 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016109http_auth_pass : string
16110 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16111 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16112 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16113
16114http_auth_type : string
16115 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16116 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16117 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16118
16119http_auth_user : string
16120 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16121 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16122 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016125 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16126 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16128 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016130method : integer + string
16131 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16132 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16133 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16134 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16135 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16136 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16137 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139 ACL derivatives :
16140 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142 Example :
16143 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16144 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16145 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016147path : string
16148 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16149 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16150 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16151 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16152 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016153 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156 ACL derivatives :
16157 path : exact string match
16158 path_beg : prefix match
16159 path_dir : subdir match
16160 path_dom : domain match
16161 path_end : suffix match
16162 path_len : length match
16163 path_reg : regex match
16164 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016165
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016166query : string
16167 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16168 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16169 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16170 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016171 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016172 which stops before the question mark.
16173
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016174req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16175 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16176 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16177 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16178 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180req.ver : string
16181req_ver : string (deprecated)
16182 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16183 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16184 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186 ACL derivatives :
16187 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189res.comp : boolean
16190 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16191 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16192 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194res.comp_algo : string
16195 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16196 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16197 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199res.cook([<name>]) : string
16200scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16201 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16202 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16203 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205 ACL derivatives :
16206 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16209scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16210 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16211 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16212 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16215scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16216 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16217 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16218 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016220res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16221 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16222 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16223 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16224 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16225 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16226 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16227 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16228 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16229 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16232 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16233 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16234 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16235 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16236 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016238res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16239shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16240 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16241 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16242 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16243 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16244 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16245 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16246 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16247 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 ACL derivatives :
16250 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16251 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16252 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16253 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16254 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16255 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16256 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16257 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16258
16259res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16260shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16261 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16262 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16263 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16264 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16265 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16268shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16269 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16270 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16271 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16272 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16273 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16274 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016275
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016276res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16277 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16278 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16279 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16280 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016282res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16283shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16284 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16285 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16286 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16287 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16288 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16289 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291res.ver : string
16292resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16293 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16294 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016296 ACL derivatives :
16297 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016299set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16300 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16301 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016302 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16306 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016308status : integer
16309 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16310 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16311 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016312
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016313unique-id : string
16314 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16315 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16316 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16317 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16318 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16319 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016321url : string
16322 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16323 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16324 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16325 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16326 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16327 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16328 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330 ACL derivatives :
16331 url : exact string match
16332 url_beg : prefix match
16333 url_dir : subdir match
16334 url_dom : domain match
16335 url_end : suffix match
16336 url_len : length match
16337 url_reg : regex match
16338 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340url_ip : ip
16341 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16342 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16343 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16344 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16345 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16346 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16347 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349url_port : integer
16350 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16351 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16352 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16353 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016354
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016355urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16356url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016357 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16358 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016359 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16360 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16361 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16362 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16364 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016365 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16366 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368 ACL derivatives :
16369 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16370 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16371 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16372 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16373 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16374 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16375 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16376 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016377
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016379 Example :
16380 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16381 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16382 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16383 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016384
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016385urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16387 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16388 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016389
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016390url32 : integer
16391 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16392 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16393 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16394 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16395 is an unsigned integer.
16396
16397url32+src : binary
16398 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16399 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16400 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16401
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016402
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100164037.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16404---------------------------------------
16405
16406This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16407used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16408purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16409There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16410or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16411any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16412for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16413
16414internal.htx.data : integer
16415 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16416 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16417
16418internal.htx.free : integer
16419 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16420 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16421
16422internal.htx.free_data : integer
16423 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16424 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16425
16426internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16427 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16428 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16429 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16430
16431internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16432 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16433 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16434
16435internal.htx.size : integer
16436 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16437 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16438
16439internal.htx.used : integer
16440 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16441 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16442 direction.
16443
16444internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16445 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16446 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16447 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16448 of the special value :
16449 * head : The oldest inserted block
16450 * tail : The newest inserted block
16451 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16452
16453internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16454 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16455 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16456 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16457 integer or one of the special value :
16458 * head : The oldest inserted block
16459 * tail : The newest inserted block
16460 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16461
16462internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16463 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16464 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16465 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16466 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16467
16468 * head : The oldest inserted block
16469 * tail : The newest inserted block
16470 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16471
16472internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16473 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16474 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16475 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16476 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16477
16478 * head : The oldest inserted block
16479 * tail : The newest inserted block
16480 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16481
16482internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16483 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16484 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16485 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16486 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16487
16488 * head : The oldest inserted block
16489 * tail : The newest inserted block
16490 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16491
16492internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16493 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16494 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16495 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16496 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16497
16498 * head : The oldest inserted block
16499 * tail : The newest inserted block
16500 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16501
16502internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16503 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16504 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16505 it returns false.
16506
16507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165087.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016509---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016511Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16512every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016513order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016515ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16516---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016517FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016518HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016519HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16520HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016521HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16522HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16523HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16524HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16525LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016526METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016527METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016528METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16529METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16530METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16531METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016532METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016533METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016534RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016535REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016536TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016537WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16538---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016539
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165418. Logging
16542----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016544One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16545provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16546very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16547provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16548state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016549to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016550headers.
16551
16552In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16553about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16554send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16555
16556 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16557 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16558 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16559 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16560 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016561 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016562 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016563
16564The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16565allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16566as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16567while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16568real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16569delay.
16570
16571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165728.1. Log levels
16573---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016574
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016575TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016576source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016577HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16578in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16579track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16580syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16581about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016582
16583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165848.2. Log formats
16585----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016586
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016587HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016588and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16589slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16590options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016591
16592 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16593 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16594 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16595 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16596 extents.
16597
16598 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16599 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16600 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16601 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16602 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16603
16604 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16605 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16606 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16607 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16608 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16609
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016610 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16611 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16612 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16613 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16614
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016615 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16616
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016617Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16618specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16619field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16620servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16621always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16622identifier.
16623
16624Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16625 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16626 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16627 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16628 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16629
16630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166318.2.1. Default log format
16632-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016633
16634This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16635as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16636format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16637
16638 Example :
16639 listen www
16640 mode http
16641 log global
16642 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16643
16644 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16645 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16646 (www/HTTP)
16647
16648 Field Format Extract from the example above
16649 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16650 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16651 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16652 4 'to' to
16653 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16654 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16655
16656Detailed fields description :
16657 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16658 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16659 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16660 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16661 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16662 and processed the connection.
16663 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16664
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016665In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16666"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16667connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16668
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016669It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16670will eventually disappear.
16671
16672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166738.2.2. TCP log format
16674---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016675
16676The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16677is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16678information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16679counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16680emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16681environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16682the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16683sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016684specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16685not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16686fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16687marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016688
16689 Example :
16690 frontend fnt
16691 mode tcp
16692 option tcplog
16693 log global
16694 default_backend bck
16695
16696 backend bck
16697 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16698
16699 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16700 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16701 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16702
16703 Field Format Extract from the example above
16704 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16705 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16706 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16707 4 frontend_name fnt
16708 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16709 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16710 7 bytes_read* 212
16711 8 termination_state --
16712 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16713 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16714
16715Detailed fields description :
16716 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016717 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16718 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16719 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016720 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016721 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016722 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016723
16724 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016725 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16726 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16727 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016728
16729 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16730 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16731 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016732 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16733 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16734 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16735 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016736
16737 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16738 and processed the connection.
16739
16740 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16741 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16742 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16743 applications.
16744
16745 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16746 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16747 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16748 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16749 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16750
16751 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16752 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16753 See "Timers" below for more details.
16754
16755 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16756 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16757 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16758 "Timers" below for more details.
16759
16760 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016761 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016762 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16763 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16764 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16765 details.
16766
16767 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16768 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16769 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16770 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16771 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16772
16773 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16774 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16775 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16776 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16777 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16778 for more details.
16779
16780 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016781 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016782 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16783 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16784 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016785 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016786
16787 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16788 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16789 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16790 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16791 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16792 caused by a denial of service attack.
16793
16794 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16795 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16796 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16797 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16798 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16799 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16800 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16801 denial of service attack.
16802
16803 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16804 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16805 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16806 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16807 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16808 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16809 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16810 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16811 be processed than on other servers.
16812
16813 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16814 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16815 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16816 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16817 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16818 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16819 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16820 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16821 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16822 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16823 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16824 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16825 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16826
16827 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16828 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16829 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16830 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16831 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16832 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016833 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016834 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16835
16836 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16837 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16838 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16839 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16840 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16841 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016842 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016843 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16844 occurs.
16845
16846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168478.2.3. HTTP log format
16848----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016849
16850The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16851is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16852the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16853are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16854emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16855generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16856"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16857which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016858frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16859is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016860
16861Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16862slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16863with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16864
16865 Example :
16866 frontend http-in
16867 mode http
16868 option httplog
16869 log global
16870 default_backend bck
16871
16872 backend static
16873 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16874
16875 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16876 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16877 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016878 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016879
16880 Field Format Extract from the example above
16881 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16882 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016883 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016884 4 frontend_name http-in
16885 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016886 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016887 7 status_code 200
16888 8 bytes_read* 2750
16889 9 captured_request_cookie -
16890 10 captured_response_cookie -
16891 11 termination_state ----
16892 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16893 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16894 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16895 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16896 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016897
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016898Detailed fields description :
16899 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016900 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16901 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16902 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016903 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016904 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016905 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016906
16907 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016908 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16909 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16910 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016911
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016912 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16913 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016914
16915 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16916 and processed the connection.
16917
16918 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16919 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16920 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16921
16922 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16923 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16924 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16925 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16926 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16927 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16928
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016929 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16930 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16931 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016932 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016933 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16934 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016935 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16936 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016937
16938 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16939 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016940 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016941
16942 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16943 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016944 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16945 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016946
16947 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16948 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16949 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16950 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16951 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016952 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16953 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016954
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016955 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16956 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16957 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16958 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16959 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16960 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16961 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016962 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016963
16964 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16965 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16966 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16967
16968 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16969 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016970 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016971 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16972 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16973 overflowing.
16974
16975 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16976 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16977 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16978 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16979 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16980 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16981 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16982 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16983
16984 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16985 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16986 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16987 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16988 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16989 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16990 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16991 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16992
16993 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16994 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16995 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16996 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16997 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16998 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16999 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17000
17001 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017002 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017003 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17004 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17005 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017006 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017007 system.
17008
17009 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17010 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17011 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17012 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17013 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17014 caused by a denial of service attack.
17015
17016 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17017 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17018 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17019 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17020 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17021 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17022 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17023 denial of service attack.
17024
17025 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17026 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17027 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17028 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17029 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17030 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17031 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17032 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17033 processed than on other servers.
17034
17035 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17036 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17037 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17038 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17039 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17040 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17041 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17042 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17043 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17044 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17045 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17046 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17047 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17048
17049 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17050 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17051 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17052 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17053 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17054 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017055 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017056 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17057
17058 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17059 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17060 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17061 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17062 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17063 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017064 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017065 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17066 occurs.
17067
17068 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17069 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17070 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17071 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17072 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17073 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17074 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17075 cookies" below for more details.
17076
17077 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17078 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17079 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17080 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17081 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17082 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17083 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17084 and cookies" below for more details.
17085
17086 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17087 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17088 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17089 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17090 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17091 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17092 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17093 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17094
17095
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200170968.2.4. Custom log format
17097------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017098
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017099The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017100mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017101
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017102HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017103Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17104separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17105prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17106
17107Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17108variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017109("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017110
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017111If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017112as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017113less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17114the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17115
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017116Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017117In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017118in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017119
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017120Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17121'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17122https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17123such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17124
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017125Flags are :
17126 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017127 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017128 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17129 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017130
17131 Example:
17132
17133 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17134 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17135
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017136 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17137
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017138At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17139
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017140 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17141 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017142
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017143the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017144
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017145 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17146 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17147 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017148
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017149and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017151 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17152 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017153
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017154Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17155
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017156 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017157 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017158 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17159 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17160 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017161 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17162 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17163 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017164 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017165 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17166 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017167 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017168 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17169 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017170 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017171 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017172 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017173 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017174 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017175 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017176 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017177 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17178 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17179 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17180 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17181 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017182 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017183 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17184 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017185 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017186 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17187 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017188 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17189 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17190 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017191 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017192 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17193 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017194 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017195 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17196 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17197 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017198 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017199 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017200 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17201 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17202 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17203 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017204 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017205 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017206 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017207 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017208 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017209 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017210 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17211 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17212 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017213 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017214 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17215 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017216 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017217 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17218 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017219 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017220 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017221 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017222 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017223
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017224 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017225
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017226
172278.2.5. Error log format
17228-----------------------
17229
17230When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17231protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17232By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17233"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017234will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017235logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17236
17237The format looks like this :
17238
17239 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17240 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17241 Connection error during SSL handshake
17242
17243 Field Format Extract from the example above
17244 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17245 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17246 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17247 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17248 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17249
17250These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17251failures.
17252
17253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172548.3. Advanced logging options
17255-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017256
17257Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17258just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17259options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17260for more information about their usage.
17261
17262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172638.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17264------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017265
17266It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17267haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17268commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17269monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17270ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17271
17272 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17273 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17274 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17275 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17276
17277 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17278 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17279 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017280 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017281 such as other load-balancers.
17282
17283 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17284 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17285 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17286
17287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172888.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17289----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017290
17291The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17292what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17293or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017294"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17296log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17297after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17298is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17299with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17300with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17301
17302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173038.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17304------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017305
17306Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17307for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17308"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17309retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17310raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17311a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17312file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17313you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17314"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17315
17316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173178.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17318--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017319
17320Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17321multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17322them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17323"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17324logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17325error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17326and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17327too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17328useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17329alternative.
17330
17331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173328.4. Timing events
17333------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017334
17335Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17336reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17337the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17338frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017339mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17340addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17341
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017342Timings events in HTTP mode:
17343
17344 first request 2nd request
17345 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17346 t tr t tr ...
17347 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17348 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17349 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17350 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17351 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17352
17353Timings events in TCP mode:
17354
17355 TCP session
17356 |<----------------->|
17357 t t
17358 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17359 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17360 |<------ Tt ------->|
17361
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017362 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017363 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017364 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17365 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17366 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017367 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017368 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17369 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17370 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17371 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017372
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017373 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17374 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17375 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017376 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17377 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17378 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17379 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17380 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17381 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017382
17383 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17384 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17385 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17386 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17387 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17388 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17389 request typed by hand during a test.
17390
17391 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17392 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017393 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017394 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17395 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17396 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17397 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017398
17399 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17400 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17401 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17402 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17403 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17404
17405 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17406 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17407 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17408 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17409 connection never established.
17410
17411 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17412 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17413 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17414 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17415 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17416 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17417 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17418 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17419 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17420 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17421 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17422
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017423 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17424 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17425 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17426 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17427 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17428 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17429
17430 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17431
17432 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17433 "Ta" can never be negative.
17434
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017435 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17436 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017437 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17438 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017439 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017440
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017441 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017442
17443 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017444 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17445 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017446
17447These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17448protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17449that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017450due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17451"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17452that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017453
17454Most common cases :
17455
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017456 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17457 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17458 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17459 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17460 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17461 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17462 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17463 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17464 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17465 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17466 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017467 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017468
17469 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17470 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17471 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17472 of ms on remote networks.
17473
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017474 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17475 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17476 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017478 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17479 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17480 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17481 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17482 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17483 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17484 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17485 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17486 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017487
17488Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17489
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017490 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017491 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017492 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017493
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017494 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017495 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17496 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17497
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017498 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017499 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17500 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17501 flags.
17502
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017503 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17504 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017505 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17506 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17507 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17508 the client connection was maintained open.
17509
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017510 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017511 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017512 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017513 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17514
17515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175168.5. Session state at disconnection
17517-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017518
17519TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17520"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175212-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17522each of which has a special meaning :
17523
17524 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17525 session to terminate :
17526
17527 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17528
17529 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17530 server explicitly refused it.
17531
17532 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17533 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17534 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17535 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017536 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017537
17538 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17539 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017540
17541 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17542 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17543 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17544 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17545 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17546
17547 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17548 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17549 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17550 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17551 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17552
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017553 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17554 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17555
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017556 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17557 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17558 backup connections when going up.
17559
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017560 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17561
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17563 send or receive data.
17564
17565 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17566 send or receive data.
17567
17568 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17569 with nothing left in the buffers.
17570
17571 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17572
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017573 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017574 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17575
17576 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17577 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17578 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17579 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17580 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17581
17582 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17583 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17584
17585 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17586 server (HTTP only).
17587
17588 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17589
17590 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17591 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17592 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17593
17594 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17595 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17596 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17597
17598 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17599
17600 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17601 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17602
17603 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17604 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17605 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17606
17607 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17608 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017609 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17610 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017611
17612 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17613 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17614 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17615 another server.
17616
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017617 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017618 server.
17619
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017620 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17621 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17622 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17623 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17624
17625 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17626 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17627 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17628 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17629
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017630 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17631 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17632 "use-server" rule).
17633
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017634 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17635
17636 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17637 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17638
17639 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17640
17641 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17642 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17643 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17644
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017645 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17646 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017647 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017648 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17649 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17650
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017651 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17652
17653 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17654 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17655
17656 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17657
17658 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17659
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017660The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17661was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17663starvation, attacks, etc...
17664
17665The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17666alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17667easier finding and understanding.
17668
17669 Flags Reason
17670
17671 -- Normal termination.
17672
17673 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17674 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17675 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17676 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17677
17678 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17679 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17680 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17681 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17682 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17683 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017684
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017685 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17686 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017687 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017688
17689 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17690 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17691 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17692
17693 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17694 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17695 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17696 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17697 the server takes too long to respond.
17698
17699 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17700 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17701 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17702 long a time to respond.
17703
17704 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17705 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17706 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17707 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017708 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17709 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017710
17711 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17712 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17713 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17714 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17715 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017716 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017717 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17718 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17719 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17720 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17721 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17722 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17723 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17724 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017725 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017726 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17727 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17728 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017729
17730 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17731 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017732 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17733 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17734 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17735 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017736
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017737 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17738 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017740 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017741 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17742 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017743 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017744 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17745 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17746
17747 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17748 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17749 503 or 504 here.
17750
17751 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17752 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17753 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17754 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17755 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17756
17757 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17758 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017759 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017760 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17761 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17762
17763 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17764 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17765 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17766 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17767 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17768 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17769 between haproxy and the server.
17770
17771 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17772 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17773 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17774 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17775 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17776 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17777 solution is to fix the application.
17778
17779 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17780 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17781 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17782 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17783 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17784 external attacks.
17785
17786 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17787 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017788 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017789 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17790 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17791
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017792 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17793 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17794 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017795 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017796 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017797
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017798 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17799 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17800 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17801 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017802 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17803 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17804 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17805 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17806 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017807
17808 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17809 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17810 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17811 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17812
17813 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17814 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17815 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17816 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17817
17818 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17819 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17820 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17821 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17822
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017823The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17824persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17825important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17826re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17827
17828 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17829
17830 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17831 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17832 set on a GET request.
17833
17834 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17835 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017836 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017837 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17838
17839 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17840 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17841 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17842
17843 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17844 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17845 already got a cookie.
17846
17847 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17848 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17849 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17850 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17851 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17852
17853 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17854 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17855 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17856
17857 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17858 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17859 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17860
17861 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17862 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17863
17864 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17865 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17866 then advertised in the response.
17867
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178698.6. Non-printable characters
17870-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017871
17872In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17873consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17874converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17875prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17876being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17877escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17878is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17879'}' when logging headers.
17880
17881Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17882issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17883containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17884
17885Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17886the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17887performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17888
17889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17891---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017892
17893Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17894achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017895section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017896cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17897the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17898the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017899locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017900not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17901user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17902a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17903wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17904
17905 Examples :
17906 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17907 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17908
17909 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17910 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17911
17912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17914---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017915
17916Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17917proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17918the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17919server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17920
17921Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17922response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017923section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017924
17925It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017926time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17927appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017928are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17929and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17930follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17931request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17932in the logs.
17933
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017934As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17935frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17936an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17937
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017938 Example :
17939 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17940 listen proxy-out
17941 mode http
17942 option httplog
17943 option logasap
17944 log global
17945 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17946
17947 # log the name of the virtual server
17948 capture request header Host len 20
17949
17950 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17951 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17952
17953 # log the beginning of the referrer
17954 capture request header Referer len 20
17955
17956 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17957 capture response header Server len 20
17958
17959 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17960 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17961
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017962 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017963 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17964
17965 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17966 capture response header Via len 20
17967
17968 # log the URL location during a redirection
17969 capture response header Location len 20
17970
17971 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17972 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17973 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17974 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17975 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17976
17977 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17978 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17979 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17980 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017981 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017982
17983 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17984 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17985 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17986 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17987 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017988 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017989
17990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179918.9. Examples of logs
17992---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017993
17994These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17995them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17996reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17997
17998 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17999 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18000 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18001
18002 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18003 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18004
18005 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18006 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18007 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18008
18009 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18010 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18011
18012 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18013 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18014 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18015
18016 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018017 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018018 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18019 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18020
18021 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18022 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18023 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18024
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018025 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18026 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18027 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18028 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18029 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18030 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018031
18032 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018033 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018034
18035 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18036 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18037 Nothing was sent to any server.
18038
18039 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18040 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18041
18042 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18043 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018044 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018045 send a 408 return code to the client.
18046
18047 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18048 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18049
18050 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18051 5 seconds ("c----").
18052
18053 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18054 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018055 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018056
18057 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018058 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018059 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18060 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18061 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18062 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18063 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018064
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018065
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200180669. Supported filters
18067--------------------
18068
18069Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18070accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18071unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18072
18073See also : "filter"
18074
180759.1. Trace
18076----------
18077
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018078filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018079
18080 Arguments:
18081 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18082 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18083
18084 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18085 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18086 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18087 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18088
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018089 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018090 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18091 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18092 amount of the parsed data.
18093
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018094 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018095
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018096This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18097callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18098information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18099filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18100
18101Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18102tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18103a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18104
18105
181069.2. HTTP compression
18107---------------------
18108
18109filter compression
18110
18111The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18112keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018113when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18114fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18115done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18116explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18117filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18118listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18119order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018121See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18122 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018123
18124
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181259.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18126--------------------------------------------
18127
18128filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18129
18130 Arguments :
18131
18132 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18133 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18134 parsed.
18135
18136 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18137 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18138 part must be placed in its own scope.
18139
18140The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18141external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018142streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018143exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18144also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18145
18146SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18147the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18148
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018149For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018150"doc/SPOE.txt".
18151
18152Important note:
18153 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18154 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18155
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100181569.4. Cache
18157----------
18158
18159filter cache <name>
18160
18161 Arguments :
18162
18163 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18164
18165The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18166"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018167cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018168other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18169case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18170is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18171filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018172listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18173order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018174
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018175See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18176 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18177
18178
181799.5. Fcgi-app
18180-------------
18181
18182filter fcg-app <name>
18183
18184 Arguments :
18185
18186 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18187
18188The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18189request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18190reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18191used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18192implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18193used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18194fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18195used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18196order.
18197
18198See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18199 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18200
18201
1820210. FastCGI applications
18203-------------------------
18204
18205HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18206feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18207the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18208FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18209servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18210FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18211backend.
18212
18213HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18214application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18215connection.
18216
1821710.1. Setup
18218-----------
18219
1822010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18221--------------------------
18222
18223fcgi-app <name>
18224 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18225 document root must be defined.
18226
18227acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18228 Declare or complete an access list.
18229
18230 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18231 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18232 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18233 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18234 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18235
18236docroot <path>
18237 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18238 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18239 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18240
18241index <script-name>
18242 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18243 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18244 is an optional setting.
18245
18246 Example :
18247 index index.php
18248
18249log-stderr global
18250log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18251 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18252 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18253
18254 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18255 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18256
18257pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18258 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18259 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18260 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18261
18262 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18263 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18264 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18265 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18266
18267 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18268 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18269
18270path-info <regex>
18271 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18272 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18273 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18274 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18275 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18276
18277 Example :
18278 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18279
18280option get-values
18281no option get-values
18282 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18283
18284 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18285 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18286
18287 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18288 application will accept.
18289
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018290 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18291 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018292
18293 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18294 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18295 option is disabled.
18296
18297 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18298 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18299 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18300 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18301 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18302 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18303
18304option keep-conn
18305no option keep-conn
18306 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18307 sending a response.
18308
18309 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18310 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18311
18312option max-reqs <reqs>
18313 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18314 accept.
18315
18316 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18317 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18318 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18319 to 1.
18320
18321option mpxs-conns
18322no option mpxs-conns
18323 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18324
18325 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18326 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18327
18328set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18329 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18330 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18331 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18332 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18333
18334 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18335 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18336 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18337
18338 Example :
18339 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18340 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18341
18342 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18343
18344
1834510.1.2. Proxy section
18346---------------------
18347
18348use-fcgi-app <name>
18349 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18350
18351 Arguments :
18352 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18353
18354 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18355 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18356 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18357 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18358 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18359
18360 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18361 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18362 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18363 application are evaluated.
18364
18365
1836610.1.3. Example
18367---------------
18368
18369 frontend front-http
18370 mode http
18371 bind *:80
18372 bind *:
18373
18374 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18375 default_backend back-static
18376
18377 backend back-static
18378 mode http
18379 server www A.B.C.D:80
18380
18381 backend back-dynamic
18382 mode http
18383 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18384 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18385
18386 fcgi-app php-fpm
18387 log-stderr global
18388 option keep-conn
18389
18390 docroot /var/www/my-app
18391 index index.php
18392 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18393
18394
1839510.2. Default parameters
18396------------------------
18397
18398A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18399the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18400scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18401applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18402
18403 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18404 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18405 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18406 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18407 | | |
18408 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18409 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18410 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18411 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18412 | | application. |
18413 | | |
18414 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18415 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18416 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18417 | | |
18418 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18419 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18420 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18421 | | the application's configuration. |
18422 | | |
18423 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18424 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18425 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18426 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18427 | | |
18428 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18429 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18430 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18431 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18432 | | be defined. |
18433 | | |
18434 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18435 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18436 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18437 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18438 | | is not set too. |
18439 | | |
18440 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18441 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18442 | | set. |
18443 | | |
18444 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18445 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18446 | | the request. |
18447 | | |
18448 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18449 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18450 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18451 | | |
18452 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18453 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18454 | | script to process the request. |
18455 | | |
18456 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18457 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18458 | | |
18459 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18460 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18461 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18462 | | |
18463 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18464 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18465 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18466 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18467 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18468 | | |
18469 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18470 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18471 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18472 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18473 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18474 | | side. |
18475 | | |
18476 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18477 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18478 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18479 | | connected to. |
18480 | | |
18481 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18482 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18483 | | |
18484 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18485 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18486 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18487 | | |
18488 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18489
18490
1849110.3. Limitations
18492------------------
18493
18494The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18495way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18496during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18497establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18498application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18499or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18500message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18501these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18502and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18503
18504Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18505request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18506requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18507
18508About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18509into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18510fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18511"http-request" ones.
18512
18513Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18514FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18515processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18516must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18517here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018519/*
18520 * Local variables:
18521 * fill-column: 79
18522 * End:
18523 */